adiv6: use struct adiv5_ap->ap_num to contain the AP base address
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The current version
598 supports only JTAG as a transport, but other virtual transports, like DAP are planned.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @end itemize
617
618 @node About Jim-Tcl
619 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
620 @cindex Jim-Tcl
621 @cindex tcl
622
623 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
624 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
625 command interpreter.
626
627 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
628 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
629 much of anything about Tcl.
630 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
631
632 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
633 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
634 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
635 OpenOCD mailing list.
636
637 @itemize @bullet
638 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
639 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
640 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
641 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
642 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
643 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
644
645 @item @b{Missing Features}
646 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
647 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
648 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
649 enabled in OpenOCD.
650
651 @item @b{Scripts}
652 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
653 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
654 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
655
656 @item @b{Commands}
657 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
658 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
659 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
660 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
661
662 @item @b{Historical Note}
663 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
664 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
665 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
666 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
667
668 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
669 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
670 @end itemize
671
672 @node Running
673 @chapter Running
674 @cindex command line options
675 @cindex logfile
676 @cindex directory search
677
678 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
679 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
680 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
681 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
682 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
683 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
684 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
685
686 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
687 tell it how each debug session should work.
688 The @option{--help} option shows:
689 @verbatim
690 bash$ openocd --help
691
692 --help | -h display this help
693 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
694 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
695 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
696 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
697 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
698 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
699 --command | -c run <command>
700 @end verbatim
701
702 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
703 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
704 To specify one or more different
705 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
706
707 @example
708 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
709 @end example
710
711 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
712 @enumerate
713 @item the current directory,
714 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
715 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
716 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
717 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
718 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
719 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
721 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
722 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
723 @end enumerate
724 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
725
726 @quotation Note
727 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
728 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
729 @end quotation
730
731 @section Simple setup, no customization
732
733 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
734 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
735 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
736 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
737 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
738
739 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
740 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
741 the server with some variation of one of the following:
742
743 @example
744 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
745 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 @end example
747
748 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
749 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
750 If all goes well you'll see output something like
751
752 @example
753 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
754 For bug reports, read
755 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
756 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
757 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
758 @end example
759
760 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
761 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
762 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
763
764 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
765
766 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
767 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
768 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
769 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
770 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
771 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
772 ensure that this always succeeds.
773 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
774 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
775 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
776 and then shut down without acting as a server.
777
778 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
779 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
780 those channels.
781
782 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
783 the @option{-d} option.
784
785 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
786 @option{-c} command line switch.
787
788 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
789 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
790 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
791 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
792 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
793 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
794 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
795
796 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
797 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
798
799 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
800 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
801 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
802 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
803
804 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
805 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
806
807 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
808 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
809 and start the OpenOCD server.
810 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
811 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
812 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
813 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
814
815 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
816
817 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
818 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
819 and a USB cable on the other.
820 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
821 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
822
823 @enumerate
824 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
825 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
826 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
827 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
828 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
829 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
830 debugging host.
831
832 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
833 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
834 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
835 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
836 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
837
838 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
839 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
840 with 1.2 Volt boards.
841
842 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
843 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
844 ways to connect the cable.
845 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
846 Be sure it's firmly connected.
847
848 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
849 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
850 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
851 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
852 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
853 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
854 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
855 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
856
857 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
858 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
859 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
860 but are tedious to set up.
861 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
862 adapter signals to the right board pins.
863
864 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
865 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
866 you are using to run OpenOCD.
867 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
868
869 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
870 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
871 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
872 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
873
874 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
875 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
876 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
877
878 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
879 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
880 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
881 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
882
883 @end enumerate
884
885 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
886 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
887 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
888
889 @section Project Directory
890
891 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
892
893 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
894 single directory for your work with a given board.
895 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
896 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
897 files accessed through semihosting,
898 and for code you upload to the target board.
899 It is also the natural place to write files,
900 such as log files and data you download from the board.
901
902 @section Configuration Basics
903
904 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
905 a variety of ways you can mix them.
906 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
907
908 @itemize
909 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
910 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
911 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
912 @end itemize
913
914 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
915 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
916 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
917
918 @example
919 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
920
921 # GDB can also flash my flash!
922 gdb_memory_map enable
923 gdb_flash_program enable
924
925 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
926 @end example
927
928 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
929
930 @example
931 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
932 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
933 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
934 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
935 @end example
936
937 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
938 each supporting a different development task.
939 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
940 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
941
942 @quotation Important
943 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
944 problems with how it treats variables.
945 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
946 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
947 that can be tested in a later script.
948 @end quotation
949
950 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
951 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
952 to simplify your work.
953
954 @section User Config Files
955 @cindex config file, user
956 @cindex user config file
957 @cindex config file, overview
958
959 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
960 in one place.
961 One of the following will match your situation best:
962
963 @itemize
964 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
965 provided by someone else.
966 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
967 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
968 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
969 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
970 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
971 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
972
973 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
974 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
975
976 @enumerate
977 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
978 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
979 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
980 @end enumerate
981
982 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
983 The first is an interface config file.
984 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
985 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
986 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
987 meet your deadline:
988
989 @example
990 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
991 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
992 @end example
993
994 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
995 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
996 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
997 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
998
999 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1000 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1001 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1002 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1003 target and board
1004 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1005 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1006
1007 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1008 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1009 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1010 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1011
1012 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1013 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1014 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1015 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1016 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1017
1018 @quotation Note
1019 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1020 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1021 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1022 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1023 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1024 @end quotation
1025
1026 @item
1027 You may need to write some C code.
1028 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1029 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1030 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1031 a new chip architecture.
1032 @end itemize
1033
1034 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1035 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1036 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1037
1038 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1039 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1040 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1041 @itemize
1042
1043 @item
1044 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1045 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1046 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1047 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1048
1049 @item
1050 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1051 @cindex vector_catch
1052 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1053 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1054 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1055 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1056 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1057 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1058
1059 @item
1060 You might need to override some defaults.
1061 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1062 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1063
1064 @item
1065 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1066 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1067 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1068 @end itemize
1069
1070 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1071
1072 A few project-specific utility
1073 routines may well speed up your work.
1074 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1075
1076 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1077 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1078 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1079 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1080 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1081 may help:
1082
1083 @example
1084 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1085 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1086 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1087 # Leave the CPU halted.
1088 reset init
1089
1090 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1091 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1092
1093 # Start running.
1094 resume 0x20000000
1095 @}
1096 @end example
1097
1098 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1099 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1100 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1101 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1102 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1103
1104 @example
1105 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1106 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1107 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1108 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1109 reset init
1110
1111 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1112 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1113 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1114 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1115 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1116 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1118
1119 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1120 reset run
1121 @}
1122 @end example
1123
1124 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1125 from NAND.
1126 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1127 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1128 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1129
1130 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1131 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1132
1133 @section Target Software Changes
1134
1135 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1136 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1137 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1138 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1139 handling issues like:
1140
1141 @itemize @bullet
1142
1143 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1144 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1145 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1146 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1147 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1148 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1149 your debug sessions.
1150
1151 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1152 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1153 That might however be your only option.
1154
1155 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1156 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1157 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1158 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1159 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1160 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1161 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1162 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1163 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1164 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1165 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1166 instead of the whole thing.
1167 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1168 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1171 @cindex ARM semihosting
1172 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1173 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1174 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1175 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1176 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1177 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1178 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1179 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1180 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1181 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1182 NAND or SPI flash.
1183
1184 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1185 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1186 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1187 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1188 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1189
1190 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1191 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1192 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1193 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1194 registers which can be used to change various features including
1195 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1196 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1197 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1198 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1199 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1200
1201 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1202 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1203 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1204 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1205 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1206
1207 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1208 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1209 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1210 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1211 early code execution can be debugged
1212 or firmware can be replaced.
1213
1214 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1215 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1216 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1217 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1218 operations like writing to memory.)
1219
1220 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1221 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1222 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1223 various kinds of message.
1224 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1225
1226 @end itemize
1227
1228 @section Target Hardware Setup
1229
1230 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1231 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1232 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1233 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1234 working with.}
1235
1236 Common issues include:
1237
1238 @itemize @bullet
1239
1240 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1241 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1242 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1243 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1244 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1245 or one from a daughtercard).
1246 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1247 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1248
1249 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1250 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1251 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1252 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1253 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1254 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1255
1256 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1257 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1258 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1259 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1260 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1261
1262
1263 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1264 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1265 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1266 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1267 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1268 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1269 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1270
1271 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1272 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1273 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1274 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1275 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1276
1277 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1278 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1279 used to start booting.
1280
1281 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1282 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1283 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1284 multiple audio codec chips).
1285 This interacts with software
1286 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1287 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1288 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1289 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1290 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1291 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1292 audio or video codecs are used.
1293
1294 @end itemize
1295
1296 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1297 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1298 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1299 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1300 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1301 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1302 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1303 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1304 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1305 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1306
1307
1308 @node Config File Guidelines
1309 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1310
1311 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1312 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1313 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1314 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1315
1316 You should find the following directories under
1317 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1318 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1319 @itemize @bullet
1320 @item @file{interface} ...
1321 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1322 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1323 @item @file{board} ...
1324 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1325 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1326
1327 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1328 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1329 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1330 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1331 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1332 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1333 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1334 a CPU and an FPGA.
1335 @item @file{target} ...
1336 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1337 on a chip
1338 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1339 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1340 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1341 the target config file defines all of them.
1342 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1343 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1344 @end itemize
1345
1346 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1347 file may override features in any of the above files by
1348 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1349 commands specific to their situation.
1350
1351 @section Interface Config Files
1352
1353 The user config file
1354 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1355
1356 @example
1357 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1358 @end example
1359
1360 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1361 in use today with OpenOCD.
1362 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1363 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1364
1365 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1366 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1367 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1368 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1369 and need to provide a driver for it.
1370
1371 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1372 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1373 @end deffn
1374
1375 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1376 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1377 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1378 to use @command{find}, instead.
1379 @end deffn
1380
1381 @section Board Config Files
1382 @cindex config file, board
1383 @cindex board config file
1384
1385 The user config file
1386 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1387
1388 @example
1389 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1390 @end example
1391
1392 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1393 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1394 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1395
1396 @enumerate
1397 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1398 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1399 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1400 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1401 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1402 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1403 @end enumerate
1404
1405 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1406 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1407 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1408 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1409
1410 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1411 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1412 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1413 configuration works.
1414
1415 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1416
1417 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1418 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1419 convention on how to use certain variables.
1420
1421 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1422 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1423 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1424 used at will within a target configuration file.
1425
1426 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1427 for a board with three chips:
1428
1429 @example
1430 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1431 set CHIPNAME network
1432 set ENDIAN big
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1439 set CHIPNAME video
1440 set ENDIAN little
1441 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1442 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1443 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1444 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1445
1446 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1447 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1448 unset ENDIAN
1449 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1450 @end example
1451
1452 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1453 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1454 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1455 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1456 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1457 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1458 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1459 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1460
1461 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1462 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1463 naming collisions.
1464
1465 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1466 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1467 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1468 up other clocks and peripherals.
1469
1470 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1471 @cindex variable names
1472
1473 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1474 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1475 one such chip (as shown above).
1476 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1477 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1478 to promote consistency and
1479 so that board files can override target defaults.
1480
1481 Inputs to target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1485 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1486 tap identifier dotted names.
1487 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1488 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1489 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1490 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1491 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1492 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1493 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1494 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1495 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1496 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1497 @end itemize
1498
1499 Outputs from target config files include:
1500
1501 @itemize @bullet
1502 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1503 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1504 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1505 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1506 specific to that board and that target.
1507 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1508 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1512 @cindex event, reset-init
1513 @cindex reset-init handler
1514
1515 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1516 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1517 fully set up yet.
1518 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1519 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1520 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1521 handler is one of the most important.
1522
1523 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1524 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1525 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1526 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1527 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1528
1529 @quotation Note
1530 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1531 are included here.
1532 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1533 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1534 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1535 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1536 @end quotation
1537
1538 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1539 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1540 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1541 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1542 those as parameters.
1543 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1544 and disabling the watchdog.
1545 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1546 the next developer doing such work.
1547 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1548
1549 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1550 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1551 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1552 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1553
1554 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1555
1556 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1557 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1558 a low JTAG clock rate.
1559 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1560 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1561 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1562 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1563 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1564 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1565 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1566
1567 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1568 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1569 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1570 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1571 which might be less than that.
1572
1573 @quotation Warning
1574 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1575 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1576 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1577 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1578 @end quotation
1579
1580 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1581 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1582 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1583 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1584 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1585 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1586
1587 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1588 @subsection The init_board procedure
1589 @cindex init_board procedure
1590
1591 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1592 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1593 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1594 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1595 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1596 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1597 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1598 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1599 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1600 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1601 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1602 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1603
1604 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1605 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1606
1607 @example
1608 ### board_file.cfg ###
1609
1610 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1611 source [find target/target.cfg]
1612
1613 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1614 # enables fast on-board clock source
1615 # configures the chip to use it
1616 @}
1617
1618 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1619 proc init_board @{@} @{
1620 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1621
1622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1623 adapter speed 100
1624 @}
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1627 enable_fast_clock
1628 adapter speed 10000
1629 @}
1630 @}
1631 @end example
1632
1633 @section Target Config Files
1634 @cindex config file, target
1635 @cindex target config file
1636
1637 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1638 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1639 more target config files like this:
1640
1641 @example
1642 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1643 @end example
1644
1645 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1646 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1647 In summary the target files should contain
1648
1649 @enumerate
1650 @item Set defaults
1651 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1652 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1653 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1654 @item On-Chip flash
1655 @end enumerate
1656
1657 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1658 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1659 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1660
1661 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1662 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1663 can talk to the chip.
1664 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1665 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1666 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1667 and other processing engines.
1668
1669 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1670
1671 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1672 letting board config files express environment-specific
1673 differences in how things should be set up.
1674
1675 @example
1676 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1677 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1678 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1680 @} else @{
1681 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1682 @}
1683
1684 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1685 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1686 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _ENDIAN little
1689 @}
1690
1691 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1692 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1693 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1694 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1696 @} else @{
1697 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1698 @}
1699 @end example
1700 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1701
1702 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1703 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1704 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1705
1706 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1707 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1708 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1709
1710 @example
1711 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1712 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1716 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1717 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1718 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1719 for taps.
1720
1721 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1722 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1723 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1724 looks (in part) like this:
1725
1726 @example
1727 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1728 @end example
1729
1730 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1731 to source such a config file twice, with different
1732 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1733 it adds a different TAP each time.
1734
1735 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1736 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1737 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1738 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1739
1740 @example
1741 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1743 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1744 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1745 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1746 @end example
1747
1748 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1749 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1750
1751 @itemize
1752 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1753 plus a JRC to enable them
1754 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1755 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1756 is not currently used)
1757 @end itemize
1758
1759 @subsection Add CPU targets
1760
1761 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1762 GDB and other commands can use it.
1763 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1764 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1765 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1766 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1767
1768 @example
1769 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1770 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1771 @end example
1772
1773 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1774 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1775 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1776 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1777 a work area if you can.
1778 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1779
1780 @example
1781 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1782 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1783 @end example
1784
1785 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1786 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1787 @cindex SMP
1788 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1789
1790 @example
1791 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1792 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1797 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1798 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 @end example
1800 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1801 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1802 @itemize @bullet
1803 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1804 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1805 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1806 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1807 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1808 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1809 @end itemize
1810
1811 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1812 command have been implemented.
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1815 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1816 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1817 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1818 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1819 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1820 following example.
1821 @end itemize
1822
1823 @example
1824 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1826 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1830 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1832 > resume
1833 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1834 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1835 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1836 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1840 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1841 @end example
1842
1843
1844 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1845
1846 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1847 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1848 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1849
1850 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1851 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1852 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1853 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1854 both signals.
1855
1856 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1857 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1858 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1859 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1860 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1861 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1862 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1863 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1864 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1865 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1866 not available.)
1867
1868 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1869 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1870 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1871 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1872 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1873 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1874 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1875 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1876
1877 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1878 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1879 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1880 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1881 slower clock than they will use later.
1882 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1883 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1884 than they will use later.
1885 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1886
1887 @quotation Important
1888 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1889 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1890 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1891 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1892 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1893 @end quotation
1894
1895 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1896 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1897 @cindex init_targets procedure
1898
1899 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1900 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1901 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1902 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1903 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1904 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1905 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1906 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1907 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1908
1909 @example
1910 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1911
1912 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1913 # basic initialization procedure ...
1914 @}
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1919 @}
1920
1921 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1924
1925 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1926 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1927 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1928 @}
1929 @end example
1930
1931 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1932 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1933
1934 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1935
1936 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1938
1939 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1940 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1941 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1942
1943 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1944 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1945 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1946 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1947 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1948 events already assigned.
1949
1950 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1951
1952 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1953 special high speed download features - enable it.
1954
1955 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1956
1957 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1958 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1959 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1960 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1961 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1962 If you are using an external trace port,
1963 configure it in your board config file.
1964 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1965 configure it in your target config file.
1966
1967 @example
1968 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1969 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1973
1974 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1975
1976 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1977 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1978 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1979 the TARGET (chip) file.
1980
1981 Examples:
1982 @itemize @bullet
1983 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1984 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1985 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1986 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1987 @end itemize
1988
1989 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1990 @section Translating Configuration Files
1991 @cindex translation
1992 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1993 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1994 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1995 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1996 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1997 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1998
1999 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2000 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2001 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2002 convert other scripts later on.
2003
2004 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2005 replace job:
2006
2007 @example
2008 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2009 #
2010 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2011 #
2012 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2013 #
2014 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2015
2016 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2017 global TARGETNAME
2018
2019 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2020
2021 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2022 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2023 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2024 @}
2025 @end example
2026
2027
2028
2029 @node Server Configuration
2030 @chapter Server Configuration
2031 @cindex initialization
2032 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2033 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2034 supported.
2035
2036 @anchor{configurationstage}
2037 @section Configuration Stage
2038 @cindex configuration stage
2039 @cindex config command
2040
2041 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2042 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2043 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2044 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2045 inside startup scripts.
2046
2047 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2048 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2049 which may be issued interactively.
2050 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2051 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2052
2053 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2054 flash banks,
2055 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2056 and other basic setup.
2057 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2058 may access or activate TAPs.
2059 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2060 longer be issued.
2061
2062 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2063 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2064 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2065 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2066 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2067
2068 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2069 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2070 the command can be executed in either
2071 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2072 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2073 @end deffn
2074
2075 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2076 @section Entering the Run Stage
2077
2078 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2079 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2080 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2081 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2082 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2083 You should see no errors at this point.
2084 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2085 commands you used to configure the server.
2086 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2087 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2088 on the scan chain.
2089
2090 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2091 become available.
2092 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2093 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2094 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2095 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2096 entry to the run stage.
2097
2098 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2099 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2100 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2101 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2102 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2103 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2104 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2105
2106 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2107 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2108 configuration files and/or command line options.
2109
2110 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2111 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2112 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2113 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2114 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2115
2116 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2117 corresponding subsystems:
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2119 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2120 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2121 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2122 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2123 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2124 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2128 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2129 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2130 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2131 @example
2132 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2133 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2134 @end example
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2138 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2139 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2140 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2141 the run stage.
2142 @end deffn
2143
2144 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2145 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2146 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2147
2148 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2149 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2150 scan chain.
2151 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2152 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2153
2154 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2155 they return.
2156 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2157 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2158 @end deffn
2159
2160 @anchor{tcpipports}
2161 @section TCP/IP Ports
2162 @cindex TCP port
2163 @cindex server
2164 @cindex port
2165 @cindex security
2166 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2167 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2168 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2169
2170 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2171 access using one or more of these ports.
2172 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2173 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2174 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2175
2176 @anchor{gdb_port}
2177 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2178 @cindex GDB server
2179 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2180 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2181 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2182 the normal use cases.
2183
2184 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2185 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2186 disables the gdb server.
2187
2188 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2189 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2190
2191 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2192 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2193 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2194
2195 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2196 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2197 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2198 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2199 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2200 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2201 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2202 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2203 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2204
2205 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2206 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2207 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2211 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2212 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2213 output from the Tcl engine.
2214 Intended as a machine interface.
2215 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2216 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2217 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2218 @end deffn
2219
2220 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2221 Specify or query the
2222 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2223 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2224 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2225 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2226 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2230 @section GDB Configuration
2231 @cindex GDB
2232 @cindex GDB configuration
2233 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2234 The ones listed here are static and global.
2235 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2236 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2237
2238 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2239 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2240 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2241 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2242 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2243 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2244 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2248 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2249 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2250 vFlash packet is received.
2251 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2252 @end deffn
2253
2254 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2255 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2256 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2257 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2258 for flash programming to work.
2259 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2260 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2261 @end deffn
2262
2263 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2264 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2265 by GDB memory read packets.
2266 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2267 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2271 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2272 packets report errors or not.
2273 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2274 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2275 @end deffn
2276
2277 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2278 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2280 @end deffn
2281
2282 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2283 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2284
2285 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2286 @end deffn
2287
2288 @anchor{eventpolling}
2289 @section Event Polling
2290
2291 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2292 where significant events can happen at any time.
2293 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2294 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2295 or to GDB.
2296
2297 Examples of such events include:
2298
2299 @itemize
2300 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2301 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2302 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2303 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2304 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2305 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2306 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2307 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2308 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2309 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2310 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2311 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2312 @end itemize
2313
2314 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2315 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2316 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2317 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2318 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2319
2320 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2321 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2322 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2323 to the various active targets.
2324 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2325 which is normally done in the background.
2326
2327 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2328 Poll the current target for its current state.
2329 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2330 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2331 specific information about the current state is printed.
2332 An optional parameter
2333 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2334
2335 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2336 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2337 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2338 @example
2339 > poll
2340 background polling: on
2341 target state: halted
2342 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2343 current mode: Supervisor
2344 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2345 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2346 >
2347 @end example
2348 @end deffn
2349
2350 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2351 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2352 @cindex config file, interface
2353 @cindex interface config file
2354
2355 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2356 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2357 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2358
2359 @quotation Note
2360 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2361 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2362 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2363 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2364 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2365 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2366 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2367 @end quotation
2368
2369 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2370 through commands in an interface configuration
2371 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2372 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2373
2374 @example
2375 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2376 @end example
2377
2378 These commands tell
2379 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2380 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2381
2382 @example
2383 # jlink interface
2384 adapter driver jlink
2385 @end example
2386
2387 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2388
2389
2390 @section Adapter Configuration
2391
2392 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2393 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2394 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2395
2396 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2397 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2398 target.
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2402 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2403 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2404 @end deffn
2405 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2406 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2407 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2408 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2409 the hardware can support.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2415 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2419 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2420 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2421 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2422 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2423 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2424 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2425
2426 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2430 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2431 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2432 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2433 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2434 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2435 @end deffn
2436
2437 @section Interface Drivers
2438
2439 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2440 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2441 available at run time.
2442
2443 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2444 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2445 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2446 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2447
2448 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2449 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2450 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2454 Displays status of RTCK option.
2455 Optionally sets that option first.
2456 @end deffn
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2460 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2461 This has one driver-specific command:
2462
2463 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2464 Logs some status
2465 @end deffn
2466 @end deffn
2467
2468 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2469 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2470 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2471 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2472 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2473 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2477 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2478 or v2 (USB bulk).
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2481 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2482 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2483 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2484 @example
2485 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2486 @end example
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2490 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2491
2492 @itemize @minus
2493 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2494 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2495 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2496 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2497 @end itemize
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2501 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2502 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2503 interface string or for user class interface.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2507 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2511 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2512 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2513
2514 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2515 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2516 are logged.
2517 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2522 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2526 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2530 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2531 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2532
2533 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2534 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2535
2536 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2537 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2538
2539 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2540 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2541 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2542 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2543 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2544 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2545
2546 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2547 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2548 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2549 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2550 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2551
2552 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2553 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2554 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2555 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2556
2557 @itemize @minus
2558 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2559 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2560 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2561 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2562 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2563 switching data and direction as necessary
2564 @end itemize
2565
2566 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2567 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2568
2569 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2570 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2571 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2572 @example
2573 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2574 @end example
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2578 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2579 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2580 during device selection.
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2584 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2585 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2589 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2590 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2591 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2592 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2593 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2594 and initially asserted reset signals.
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2598 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2599 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2600 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2601 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2602 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2603 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2604 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2605 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2606 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2607 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2608
2609 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2610 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2611 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2612 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2613 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2614 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2615
2616 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2617 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2618 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2619 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2620 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2621 are always driven by the FTDI.
2622
2623 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2624 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2625 @var{name}.
2626 @end deffn
2627
2628 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2629 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{0}, drive low
2632 @item @option{1}, drive high
2633 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2634 @end itemize
2635 @end deffn
2636
2637 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2638 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2642 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2643
2644 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2645 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2646 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2647 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2648 @itemize @minus
2649 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2650 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2651 @end itemize
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2655 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2656
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2660 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2661 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2662 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2663
2664 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2665 @itemize @minus
2666 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2667 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2668 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2669 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2670 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2671 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2675 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2676 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2677 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2678 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2679 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2680 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2681 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2682
2683 FT232R
2684 @itemize @minus
2685 @item bit 7 - RI
2686 @item bit 6 - DCD
2687 @item bit 5 - DSR
2688 @item bit 4 - DTR
2689 @item bit 3 - CTS
2690 @item bit 2 - RTS
2691 @item bit 1 - RXD
2692 @item bit 0 - TXD
2693 @end itemize
2694
2695 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2696 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2699 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2700 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2704 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2705 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2706 @end deffn
2707
2708 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2709 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2710 @end deffn
2711
2712 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2713 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2714 @end deffn
2715
2716 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2717 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2721 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2725 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2729 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2730 @end deffn
2731
2732 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2733 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2734 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2735 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2736 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2737 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2738 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2739 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2740 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2741 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2747 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2748 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2749 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2750
2751 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2752 processors which are being simulated.
2753
2754 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2755 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2756 sockets instead of TCP.
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2760 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2761 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2765 something like:
2766
2767 @example
2768 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2769 remote_bitbang port 3335
2770 remote_bitbang host foobar
2771 @end example
2772
2773 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2774 named mysocket:
2775
2776 @example
2777 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2778 remote_bitbang port 0
2779 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2780 @end example
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2784 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2785 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2786 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2787
2788 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2789 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2790 default values are used.
2791 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2792 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2793 @example
2794 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2795 @end example
2796 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2797 @example
2798 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2799 @end example
2800 @end deffn
2801
2802 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2803 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2804 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2805 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2806 target board.
2807
2808 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2809 @example
2810 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2811 reset_config srst_only
2812 @end example
2813 @end deffn
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2816 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2817 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2818 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2819 @end deffn
2820
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2822 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2823 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2824 @end deffn
2825
2826 @end deffn
2827
2828 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2829 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2830 This has one driver-specific command:
2831
2832 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2833 Display either the address of the I/O port
2834 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2835 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2836 This is a write-once setting.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @end deffn
2839
2840 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2841 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2842 transports.
2843
2844 @quotation Compatibility Note
2845 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2846 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2847 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2848 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2849 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2850 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2851 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2852 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2853 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2854 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2855 @end quotation
2856
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2858 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2859 states.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2862 Display free device internal memory.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2865 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2866 command version.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2869 Display the device configuration.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2872 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2873 power state.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2876 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2877 @end deffn
2878 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2879 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2880 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2881 IP configuration.
2882 @end deffn
2883 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2884 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2885 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2886 @end deffn
2887 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2888 Reset the current configuration.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2891 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2892 @end deffn
2893 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2894 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2895 pairs.
2896
2897 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2898 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2899 @example
2900 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2901 @end example
2902 @end deffn
2903 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2904 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2905 pairs.
2906
2907 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2908 @example
2909 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2910 77a90000
2911 @end example
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2914 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2915 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2916 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2917 the serial number instead, if possible.
2918
2919 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2924 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2925 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2926 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2927 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2928 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2929 configuration script.
2930
2931 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2932 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2933 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2934 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2935 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2936
2937 Known limitations:
2938 @itemize @bullet
2939 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2940 and 2.7 MHz.
2941 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2942 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2943 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2944 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2945 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2946 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2947 communications with the target.
2948 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2949 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2950 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2951 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2952 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2953 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2954 @end itemize
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2957 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2958 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2962 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2963 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2964 target as a side-effect.
2965 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2969 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2970 version, and target voltage.
2971 @end deffn
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2975 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2976 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2977 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2978 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2981 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2982 This is a write-once setting.
2983 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2984
2985 @itemize @minus
2986 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2987 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2988 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2989 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2990 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2991 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2992 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2993 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2994 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2995 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2996 some versions of
2997 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2998 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2999 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3000 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3001 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3002 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3003 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3004 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3005 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3006 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3007 @end itemize
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3011 Display either the address of the I/O port
3012 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3013 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3014 This is a write-once setting.
3015
3016 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3017 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3018 you may encounter a problem.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3022 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3023 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3024 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3025 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3026 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3027
3028 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3029 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3030 @quotation Tip
3031 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3032 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3033 @example
3034 > parport toggling_time 1000
3035 > adapter speed 500
3036 @end example
3037 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3038 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3039 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3040 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3041 large set of samples.
3042 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3043 @example
3044 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3045 @end example
3046 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3047 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3048
3049 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3050 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3051 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3052 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3053 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3054 be conservative.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3059 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3060 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3064 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3065
3066 @example
3067 adapter driver parport
3068 parport port 0x278
3069 parport cable wiggler
3070 @end example
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3074 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3078 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3082 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3086 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3087
3088 @quotation Note
3089 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3090 which are not currently documented here.
3091 @end quotation
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @anchor{hla_interface}
3095 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3096 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3097 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3098 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3099
3100 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3101 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3102 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3103 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3104 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3105 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3106
3107 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3108 Currently Not Supported.
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3112 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3116 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3117 @end deffn
3118
3119 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3120 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3121 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3122
3123 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3124 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3125 ST-LINK server software module}.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3129 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3130 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3131 @end deffn
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3135 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3136 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3137 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3138 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3139
3140 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3141 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3142 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3143 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3144
3145 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3146 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3149 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3150 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3151
3152 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3153 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3154 ST-LINK server software module}.
3155
3156 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3160 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3164 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3165 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3166
3167 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3168 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3169 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3170 the target's supply voltage.
3171 @example
3172 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3173 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3174 @end example
3175 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3176 @example
3177 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3178 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3179 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3180 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3181 3.24891518738
3182 @end example
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3187 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3188 @end deffn
3189
3190 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3191 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3195 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3196 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3197 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3198 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3199
3200 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3201 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3202 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3203 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3207 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3208 version).
3209 @end deffn
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3213 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3214 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3215 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3216 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3217
3218 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3221 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3222
3223 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3224 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3225
3226 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3227
3228 @end deffn
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3232 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3233 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3234
3235 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3236 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3237 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3238 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3239 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3240 configuration on exit.
3241
3242 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3243
3244 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3245 pinout.
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3248 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3249 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3250 individually.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3254 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3255 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3259 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3260 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3264 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3265 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3269 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3270 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3274 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3275 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3279 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3280 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3281 @end deffn
3282
3283 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3284 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3285 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3289 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3290 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3291 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3295 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3299 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3303 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3304 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3308 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3309 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3310 list can be found in the
3311 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3317 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3318 of the one which is most popular.
3319
3320 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3321
3322 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3323 pinout.
3324
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327
3328 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3329 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3330 on the two expansion headers.
3331
3332 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3333 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3334 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3335 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3336
3337 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIOs numbered 0 to 31 are mapped to GPIO port
3338 0, GPIO numbers 32 to 63 are mapped to GPIO port 1 and so on.
3339
3340 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3341
3342 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3343 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3344 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3345 individually.
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3349 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3350 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3354 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3355 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3356 @end deffn
3357
3358 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3359 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3360 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3361 @end deffn
3362
3363 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3364 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3365 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3369 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3370 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3374 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3375 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3379 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3380 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio_dir}
3384 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3385 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin. The direction
3386 control state can be set with the command @command{am335xgpio
3387 swdio_dir_output_state}. If not specified this feature is disabled.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_output_state} @var{output_state}
3391 Set the state required for an external SWDIO buffer to be an output. Valid
3392 values are @option{on} (default) and @option{off}.
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3396 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3400 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3401 @end deffn
3402
3403 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_num} @var{led}
3404 Set activity LED GPIO number. If not specified an activity LED is not enabled.
3405 @end deffn
3406
3407 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_on_state} @var{on_state}
3408 Set required logic level for the LED to be on. Valid values are @option{on}
3409 (default) and @option{off}.
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3413 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3414 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3415 @end deffn
3416
3417 @end deffn
3418
3419
3420 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3421 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3422 The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through bitbanging.
3423
3424 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3425
3426 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod gpiochip} @var{chip}
3427 Set the GPIO chip number for all GPIOs used by linuxgpiod. If GPIOs use
3428 different GPIO chips then the individual GPIO configuration commands (i.e., not
3429 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums} or @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}) can be used to
3430 set chip numbers independently for each GPIO.
3431 @end deffn
3432
3433 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3434 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order). Must
3435 be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3436 individually.
3437 @end deffn
3438
3439 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tck_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tck}
3440 Set TCK GPIO number, and optionally TCK chip number. Must be specified to enable
3441 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3442 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3443 @end deffn
3444
3445 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tms_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tms}
3446 Set TMS GPIO number, and optionally TMS chip number. Must be specified to enable
3447 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3448 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3449 @end deffn
3450
3451 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tdo_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tdo}
3452 Set TDO GPIO number, and optionally TDO chip number. Must be specified to enable
3453 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3454 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3455 @end deffn
3456
3457 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tdi_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tdi}
3458 Set TDI GPIO number, and optionally TDI chip number. Must be specified to enable
3459 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3460 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3461 @end deffn
3462
3463 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod trst_num} [@var{chip}] @var{trst}
3464 Set TRST GPIO number, and optionally TRST chip number. Must be specified to
3465 enable TRST.
3466 @end deffn
3467
3468 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3469 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3470 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified
3471 individually.
3472 @end deffn
3473
3474 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swclk_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swclk}
3475 Set SWCLK GPIO number, and optionally SWCLK chip number. Must be specified to
3476 enable SWD transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3477 @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}.
3478 @end deffn
3479
3480 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swdio_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swdio}
3481 Set SWDIO GPIO number, and optionally SWDIO chip number. Must be specified to
3482 enable SWD transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3483 @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}.
3484 @end deffn
3485
3486 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swdio_dir_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swdio_dir}
3487 Set SWDIO direction control GPIO number, and optionally SWDIO direction control
3488 chip number. If specified, this GPIO can be used to control the direction of an
3489 external buffer connected to the SWDIO GPIO (set=output mode, clear=input mode).
3490 @end deffn
3491
3492 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod srst_num} [@var{chip}] @var{srst}
3493 Set SRST GPIO number, and optionally SRST chip number. Must be specified to
3494 enable SRST.
3495 @end deffn
3496
3497 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod led_num} [@var{chip}] @var{led}
3498 Set activity LED GPIO number, and optionally activity LED chip number. If not
3499 specified an activity LED is not enabled.
3500 @end deffn
3501
3502 @end deffn
3503
3504
3505 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3506 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3507 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3508
3509 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3510 @end deffn
3511
3512
3513 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3514 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3515 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3516
3517 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3518 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3519 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3520
3521 @itemize @minus
3522 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3523 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3524 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3525 @end itemize
3526 @end deffn
3527
3528 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3529 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3530 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3531 @end deffn
3532 @end deffn
3533
3534
3535 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3536 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3537
3538 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3539 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3540 @end deffn
3541
3542 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3543 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3544 0 for no batching
3545 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3546 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3547 @end deffn
3548
3549 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3550 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3551 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3552 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3553 timeout value.
3554 @end deffn
3555
3556 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3557 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3558 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3559 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3563 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3564 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3565 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3566 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3567 @end deffn
3568 @end deffn
3569
3570 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3571 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3572 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3573 DPI server interface.
3574
3575 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3576 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3577 @end deffn
3578
3579 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3580 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3581 @end deffn
3582 @end deffn
3583
3584
3585 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3586
3587 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3588 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3589
3590 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3591 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3592
3593 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3594 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3595 @example
3596 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3597 @end example
3598 @end deffn
3599
3600 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3601 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3602 @example
3603 buspirate speed normal
3604 @end example
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3608 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3609 @itemize @minus
3610 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3611 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3612 @end itemize
3613 For example:
3614 @example
3615 buspirate mode normal
3616 @end example
3617 @end deffn
3618
3619 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3620 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3621 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3622 For example:
3623 @example
3624 buspirate pullup 0
3625 @end example
3626 @end deffn
3627
3628 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3629 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3630 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3631 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3632 @example
3633 buspirate vreg 0
3634 @end example
3635 @end deffn
3636
3637 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3638 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3639 @end deffn
3640 @example
3641 buspirate led 1
3642 @end example
3643
3644 @end deffn
3645
3646
3647 @section Transport Configuration
3648 @cindex Transport
3649 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3650 and the debug adapter you are using,
3651 several transports may be available to
3652 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3653 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3654 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3655 version of OpenOCD.
3656 @end deffn
3657
3658 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3659 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3660
3661 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3662 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3663 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3664 adapter's driver).
3665
3666 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3667 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3668 supported by the debug adapter.
3669
3670 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3671 transport, if any.
3672 @end deffn
3673
3674 @subsection JTAG Transport
3675 @cindex JTAG
3676 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3677 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3678 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3679 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3680 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3681 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3682
3683 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3684 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3685 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3686 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3687 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3688
3689 @subsection SWD Transport
3690 @cindex SWD
3691 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3692 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3693 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3694 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3695 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3696 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3697 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3698
3699 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3700 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3701 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3702 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3703 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3704
3705 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3706 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3707 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3708 expected to change.
3709 @end deffn
3710
3711 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3712 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3713 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3714 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3715 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3716 DAPs are created.
3717
3718 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3719 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3720 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3721
3722 @subsection SPI Transport
3723 @cindex SPI
3724 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3725 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3726 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3727 solution for flash programming.
3728
3729 @anchor{swimtransport}
3730 @subsection SWIM Transport
3731 @cindex SWIM
3732 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3733 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3734 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3735 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3736
3737 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3738
3739 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3740
3741 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3742 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3743 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3744 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3745 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3746
3747 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3748 @section JTAG Speed
3749 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3750 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3751 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3752 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3753 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3754 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3755 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3756 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3757 power management software that may be active.
3758
3759 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3760 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3761 target event handler.
3762 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3763 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3764 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3765 sets up those clocks).
3766 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3767 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3768 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3769 in the target config file.
3770 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3771 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3772 config file instead.
3773 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3774 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3775 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3776
3777 @example
3778 jtag_rclk 3000
3779 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3780 @end example
3781
3782 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3783 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3784 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3785 may not be the fastest solution.
3786
3787 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3788 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3789 which support adaptive clocking.
3790
3791 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3792 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3793 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3794 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3795 than the speed specified.
3796
3797 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3798 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3799 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3800 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3801
3802 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3803 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3804 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3805 JTAG clocking after setup.
3806 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3807 If the interface device can not
3808 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3812 @cindex adaptive clocking
3813 @cindex RTCK
3814 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3815 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3816 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3817 @example
3818 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3819 jtag_rclk 3000
3820 @end example
3821 @end defun
3822
3823 @node Reset Configuration
3824 @chapter Reset Configuration
3825 @cindex Reset Configuration
3826
3827 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3828 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3829 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3830 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3831 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3832 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3833 Please see the various board files for examples.
3834
3835 @quotation Note
3836 To maintainers and integrators:
3837 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3838 Normally the board configuration file
3839 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3840 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3841
3842 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3843 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3844 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3845 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3846 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3847 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3848 @end quotation
3849
3850 @section Types of Reset
3851
3852 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3853 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3854 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3855
3856 @itemize @bullet
3857 @item
3858 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3859 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3860 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3861 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3862 @item
3863 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3864 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3865 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3866 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3867 @item
3868 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3869 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3870 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3871 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3872 @item
3873 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3874 several other types of reset.
3875 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3876 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3877 There may be individual module resets.
3878 @end itemize
3879
3880 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3881 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3882 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3883 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3884 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3885 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3886 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3887 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3888 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3889
3890 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3891 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3892
3893 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3894 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3895 common issues are:
3896
3897 @itemize @bullet
3898
3899 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3900 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3901 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3902 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3903 when either of those signals is not connected.
3904 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3905 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3906 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3907 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3908
3909 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3910 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3911 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3912 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3913
3914 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3915 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3916 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3917 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3918 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3919 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3920 hardware debouncing.
3921 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3922 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3923
3924 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3925 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3926 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3927 to use push/pull output drivers.
3928 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3929 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3930 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3931 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3932
3933 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3934 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3935 issues (not limited to errata).
3936 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3937 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3938 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3939 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3940 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3941 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3942 @end itemize
3943
3944 There can also be other issues.
3945 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3946 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3947 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3948 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3949 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3950 Agreement (NDA).
3951
3952 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3953 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3954 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3955
3956 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3957 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3958
3959 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3960
3961 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3962 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3963 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3964 allowing it to be deasserted.
3965 @end deffn
3966
3967 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3968 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3969 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3970 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3971 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3972 @end deffn
3973
3974 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3975 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3976 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3977 allowing it to be deasserted.
3978 @end deffn
3979
3980 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3981 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3982 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3983 @end deffn
3984
3985 @anchor{reset_config}
3986 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3987 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3988 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3989 configuration scripts.
3990
3991 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3992 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3993 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3994 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3995 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3996 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3997 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3998 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3999
4000 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
4001 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
4002 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
4003 -- may be specified at a time.
4004 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
4005 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
4006 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
4007 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
4008 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
4009
4010 @itemize
4011 @item
4012 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
4013 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
4014 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
4015 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
4016 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
4017
4018 @quotation Tip
4019 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
4020 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
4021 @end quotation
4022
4023 @item
4024 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
4025 signal implementations.
4026 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
4027 indicating everything behaves normally.
4028 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
4029 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
4030 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
4031 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
4032 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
4033 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
4034 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
4035
4036 @item
4037 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4038 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
4039 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
4040 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
4041 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
4042 while SRST is asserted.
4043 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
4044 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
4045
4046 @item
4047 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4048 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
4049 is required to use this option.
4050 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
4051 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4052 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4053 be asserted before any target connection.
4054 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4055 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4056 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4057 @end itemize
4058
4059 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4060 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4061 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4062 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4063 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4064
4065 @itemize
4066 @item
4067 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4068 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4069 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4070 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4071
4072 @item
4073 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4074 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4075 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4076 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4077 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4078 @end itemize
4079 @end deffn
4080
4081 @section Custom Reset Handling
4082 @cindex events
4083
4084 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4085 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4086 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4087 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4088 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4089 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4090
4091 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4092 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4093 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4094 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4095 want to reset everything at once.
4096
4097 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4098 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4099 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4100 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4101 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4102 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4103 needs special attention.
4104
4105 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4106 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4107 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4108 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4109 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4110 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4111 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4112 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4113 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4114
4115 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4116 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4117 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4118 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4119 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4120
4121 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4122 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4123 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4124 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4125 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4126 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4127 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4128 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4129 or potentially some other value.
4130
4131 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4132 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4133 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4134 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4135 (or their associated targets)
4136 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4137
4138 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4139 they return.
4140 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4141 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4142 @end deffn
4143
4144 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4145 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4146 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4147 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4148 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4149 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4150 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4151 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4152 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4153 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4154 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4158 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4159 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4160 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4161 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164
4165 @node TAP Declaration
4166 @chapter TAP Declaration
4167 @cindex TAP declaration
4168 @cindex TAP configuration
4169
4170 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4171 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4172
4173 @itemize @bullet
4174 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4175 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4176 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4177 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4178 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4179 start running that code.
4180 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4181 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4182 and missing connections.
4183 @end itemize
4184
4185 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4186 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4187 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4188 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4189 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4190
4191 @section Scan Chains
4192 @cindex scan chain
4193
4194 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4195 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4196 They also need to be added to
4197 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4198 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4199 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4200 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4201 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4202 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4203 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4204 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4205
4206 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4207 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4208 command, presented in the next chapter.
4209 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4210 debugging targets.)
4211 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4212
4213 @verbatim
4214 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4215 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4216 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4217 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4218 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4219 @end verbatim
4220
4221 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4222 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4223 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4224 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4225 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4226 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4227 until they are told to do so.
4228
4229 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4230 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4231 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4232 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4233
4234 @example
4235 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4236 @end example
4237
4238 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4239 by a given chip.
4240 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4241 and so forth.
4242 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4243 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4244 both inside a single chip and between them.
4245 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4246
4247 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4248 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4249 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4250 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4251 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4252 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4253 includes commands something like this:
4254
4255 @example
4256 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4257 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4258 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4259 @end example
4260
4261 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4262 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4263 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4264
4265 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4266 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4267 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4268 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4269 @example
4270 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4271 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4272 @}
4273 @end example
4274 @end deffn
4275
4276 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4277 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4278 and their status.
4279 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4280 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4281 but systems with a JTAG router can
4282 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4286 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4287
4288 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4289 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4290
4291 @section TAP Names
4292 @cindex dotted name
4293
4294 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4295 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4296 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4297 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4298 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4299 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4300 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4301 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4302
4303 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4304 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4305 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4306
4307 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4308
4309 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4310 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4311 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4312
4313 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4314 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4315 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4316 overridable.
4317
4318 @cindex TAP naming convention
4319 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4320 and should follow this convention:
4321
4322 @itemize @bullet
4323 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4324 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4325 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4326 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4327 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4328 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4329 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4330 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4331 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4332 with a single TAP;
4333 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4334 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4335 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4336 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4337 @end itemize
4338
4339 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4340
4341 @itemize @bullet
4342 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4343 @*The length in bits of the
4344 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4345 @end itemize
4346
4347 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4348
4349 @itemize @bullet
4350 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4351 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4352 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4353 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4354 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4355 (the TAP is linked in).
4356 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4357 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4358 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4359 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4360 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4361 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4362 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4363 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4364 values that were found but not included in the list.
4365
4366 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4367 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4368 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4369 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4370 hardware to find these values.
4371 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4372 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4373 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4374 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4375 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4376 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4377 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4378 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4379 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4380 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4381 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4382 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4383 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4384 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4385 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4386 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4387 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4388 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4389 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4390 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4391 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4392 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4393 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4394 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4395 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4396 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4397 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4398 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4399 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4400 @end itemize
4401 @end deffn
4402
4403 @section Other TAP commands
4404
4405 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4406 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4407 @end deffn
4408
4409 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4410 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4411 At this writing this TAP attribute
4412 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4413 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4414 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4415 See the next section for information about the available events.
4416
4417 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4418 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4419 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4420 @end deffn
4421
4422 @section TAP Events
4423 @cindex events
4424 @cindex TAP events
4425
4426 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4427 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4428 The other applies to debugger targets,
4429 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4430
4431 The TAP events currently defined are:
4432
4433 @itemize @bullet
4434 @item @b{post-reset}
4435 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4436 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4437 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4438 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4439 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4440
4441 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4442 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4443 of any particular target.
4444 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4445 @item @b{setup}
4446 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4447 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4448 @item @b{tap-disable}
4449 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4450 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4451 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4452 @item @b{tap-enable}
4453 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4454 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4455 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4456 @end itemize
4457
4458 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4459 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4460 contents to be accurate), you might:
4461
4462 @example
4463 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4464 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4465 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4466 @}
4467 @end example
4468
4469
4470 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4471 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4472 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4473 @cindex jrc
4474
4475 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4476 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4477 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4478 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4479 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4480
4481 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4482 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4483 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4484 be visible.
4485 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4486 ignores, such as:
4487
4488 @itemize
4489 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4490 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4491 TAPs receive new instructions.
4492 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4493 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4494 @end itemize
4495
4496 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4497 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4498 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4499 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4500
4501 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4502 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4503
4504 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4505 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4506 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4507 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4508 should define TAP event handlers using
4509 code that looks something like this:
4510
4511 @example
4512 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4513 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4514 @}
4515 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4516 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4517 @}
4518 @end example
4519
4520 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4521
4522 @example
4523 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4524 @end example
4525
4526 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4527 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4528 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4529 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4530
4531 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4532 If necessary, disables the tap
4533 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4534 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4535 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4536 and "0" if it is disabled.
4537 @end deffn
4538
4539 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4540 If necessary, enables the tap
4541 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4542 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4543 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4544 and "0" if it is disabled.
4545 @end deffn
4546
4547 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4548 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4549 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4550 and "0" if it is disabled.
4551
4552 @quotation Note
4553 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4554 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4555 @end quotation
4556 @end deffn
4557
4558 @anchor{autoprobing}
4559 @section Autoprobing
4560 @cindex autoprobe
4561 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4562
4563 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4564 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4565 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4566 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4567
4568 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4569 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4570 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4571 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4572 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4573 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4574 right when they come out of reset).
4575
4576 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4577
4578 @example
4579 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4580 reset_config trst_and_srst
4581 jtag_rclk 8
4582 @end example
4583
4584 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4585 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4586
4587 @enumerate
4588 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4589 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4590 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4591 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4592 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4593 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4594 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4595 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4596 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4597 that is discovered.
4598 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4599 register, it will report it.
4600 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4601 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4602 @end enumerate
4603
4604 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4605 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4606 that's a bit more complex:
4607
4608 @example
4609 clock speed 8 kHz
4610 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4611 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4612 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4613 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4614 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4615 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4616 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4617 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4618 @end example
4619
4620 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4621 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4622 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4623 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4624 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4625 and so forth.
4626
4627 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4628 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4629 @cindex DAP declaration
4630
4631 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4632 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4633 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4634 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4635 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4636
4637 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4638
4639 @anchor{dap_create}
4640 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4641 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4642 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4643 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4644 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4645
4646 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4647
4648 @itemize @bullet
4649 @item @code{-adiv5}
4650 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4651 @item @code{-adiv6}
4652 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4653 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4654 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4655 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4656 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4657 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4658
4659 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4660 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4661 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4662 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4663 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4664 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4665
4666 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4667 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4668 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4669 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4670 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4671 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4672 @end itemize
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4676 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4677 for TCL scripting.
4678 @end deffn
4679
4680 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4681 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4682 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4683 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4684 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4685 @end deffn
4686
4687 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4688 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4689 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4690 initialization, too.
4691 @end deffn
4692
4693 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4694
4695 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4696 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4697 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4698 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4699 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4703 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4704 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4705 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4706 @end deffn
4707
4708 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4709 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4710 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4711 or set a new value @var{value}.
4712 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4713 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4714 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4715 @end deffn
4716
4717 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4718 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4719 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4720 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4721 @end deffn
4722
4723 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4724 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4725 value @var{value}.
4726
4727 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4728 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4729 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4730
4731 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4732 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4733 @end deffn
4734
4735 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4736 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4737 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4738 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4739 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4740 @end deffn
4741
4742 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4743 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4744 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4745 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4746 @end deffn
4747
4748 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4749 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4750
4751 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4752 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4753 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4754 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4755 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4756 for details.
4757
4758 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4759 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4760 the pattern:
4761 @example
4762 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4763 @end example
4764
4765 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4766 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4767 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4768 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4769 @example
4770 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4771 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4772 @end example
4773
4774 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4775 @example
4776 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4777 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4778 @end example
4779
4780 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4781 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4782
4783 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4784 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4785 example with a proper dap name:
4786 @example
4787 xxx.dap apcsw default
4788 @end example
4789 @end deffn
4790
4791 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4792 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4793 Disabled by default
4794 @end deffn
4795
4796
4797 @node CPU Configuration
4798 @chapter CPU Configuration
4799 @cindex GDB target
4800
4801 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4802 You can also access these targets without GDB
4803 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4804 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4805 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4806 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4807
4808 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4809 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4810
4811 @section Target List
4812 @cindex target, current
4813 @cindex target, list
4814
4815 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4816 where each member has a name.
4817 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4818 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4819 (plural!) command.
4820 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4821 look like with more than one:
4822 @verbatim
4823 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4824 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4825 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4826 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4827 @end verbatim
4828
4829 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4830 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4831 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4832 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4833 space seen by that current target.
4834 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4835 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4836 are examples; and there are many more.
4837
4838 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4839
4840 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4841 Returns the name of the current target.
4842 @end deffn
4843
4844 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4845 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4846 @example
4847 foreach t [target names] @{
4848 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4849 @}
4850 @end example
4851 @end deffn
4852
4853 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4854 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4855
4856 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4857 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4858 command names are singular.}
4859
4860 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4861 targets in a user friendly form.
4862
4863 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4864 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4865 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4866 @end deffn
4867
4868 @section Target CPU Types
4869 @cindex target type
4870 @cindex CPU type
4871
4872 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4873 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4874 when calling @command{target create}.
4875 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4876 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4877 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4878 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4879 what core-specific commands may be available
4880 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4881 and more.
4882
4883 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4884 since there's a command to list them.
4885
4886 @anchor{targettypes}
4887 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4888 Lists all supported target types.
4889 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4890
4891 @itemize @bullet
4892 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4893 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4894 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4895 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4896 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4897 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4898 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4899 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4900 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4901 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4902 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4903 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4904 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4905 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4906 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4907 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4908 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4909 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4910 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4911 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4912 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4913 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4914 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4915 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4916 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4917 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4918 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4919 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4920 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4921 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4922 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4923 support for new CPUs.
4924 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4925 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4926 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4927 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4928 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4929 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4930 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4931 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4932 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4933 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4934 @itemize @minus
4935 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4936 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4937 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4938 @end itemize
4939 And two debug interfaces cores:
4940 @itemize @minus
4941 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4942 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4943 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4944 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4945 @end itemize
4946 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4947 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4948 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4949 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4950 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4951 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4952 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4953 @end itemize
4954 @end deffn
4955
4956 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4957 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4958 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4959 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4960 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4961 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4962 reflect design generations;
4963 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4964 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4965
4966 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4967 @section Target Configuration
4968
4969 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4970 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4971 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4972 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4973 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4974
4975 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4976 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4977 optional parts.
4978 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4979 command, created as part of target creation.
4980
4981 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4982 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4983 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4984 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4985 to be much more board-specific.
4986 The key steps you use might look something like this
4987
4988 @example
4989 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4990 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4991 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4992 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4993 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4994 @end example
4995
4996 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4997 on-chip SRAM.
4998 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4999 writes to target memory;
5000 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
5001 GDB memory checksumming;
5002 and more.
5003
5004 @quotation Warning
5005 On more complex chips, the work area can become
5006 inaccessible when application code
5007 (such as an operating system)
5008 enables or disables the MMU.
5009 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
5010 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
5011 easy access to other addresses needed.
5012 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
5013 @end quotation
5014
5015 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
5016 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
5017 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
5018 controllers.
5019 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
5020 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
5021 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
5022
5023 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
5024 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
5025 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
5026 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
5027 purposes including additional configuration.
5028
5029 @itemize @bullet
5030 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
5031 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
5032 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
5033 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
5034
5035 This name is also used to create the target object command,
5036 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
5037 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
5038 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
5039 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
5040 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
5041 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
5042
5043 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5044 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5045 @end itemize
5046 @end deffn
5047
5048 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5049 The options accepted by this command may also be
5050 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5051 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5052 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5053
5054 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5055 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5056 and changing its endianness.
5057
5058 @itemize @bullet
5059
5060 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5061 used to access this target.
5062
5063 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5064 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5065 create and manage DAP instances.
5066
5067 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5068 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5069
5070 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5071 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5072 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5073 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5074 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5075 same event name assigns only one handler.
5076
5077 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5078 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5079
5080 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5081 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5082 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5083 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5084 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5085 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5086 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5087
5088 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5089 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5090 or virtual address is being used.
5091
5092 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5093 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5094
5095 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5096 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5097 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5098 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5099 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5100
5101 @anchor{rtostype}
5102 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5103 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
5104 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5105 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5106 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
5107 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5108
5109 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5110 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5111 access the target for debugging.
5112
5113 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5114 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5115 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5116 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5117 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5118
5119 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5120 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5121 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5122 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5123 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5124
5125 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5126 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5127 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5128 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5129 command @command{gdb_port}.
5130 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5131
5132 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5133 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5134 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5135 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5136 @end itemize
5137 @end deffn
5138
5139 @section Other $target_name Commands
5140 @cindex object command
5141
5142 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5143 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5144
5145 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5146 Once a button is created a button
5147 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5148 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5149 configure it like this:
5150
5151 @example
5152 # Create
5153 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5154 # Modify
5155 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5156 # Query
5157 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5158 # Report
5159 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5160 @end example
5161
5162 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5163 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5164
5165 @example
5166 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5167 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5168 @end example
5169
5170 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5171
5172 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5173 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5174 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5175 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5176 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5177 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5178 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5179 They are not otherwise documented here.
5180 @end deffn
5181
5182 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5183 Set register values of the target.
5184
5185 @itemize
5186 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5187 @end itemize
5188
5189 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5190 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5191
5192 @example
5193 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5194 @end example
5195 @end deffn
5196
5197 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5198 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5199 of register names and values.
5200 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5201 target, bypassing any caching.
5202
5203 @itemize
5204 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5205 @end itemize
5206
5207 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5208 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5209
5210 @example
5211 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5212 @end example
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5216 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5217 script.
5218
5219 @itemize
5220 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5221 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5222 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5223 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5224 @end itemize
5225
5226 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5227 memory at address 0x20000000:
5228
5229 @example
5230 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5231 @end example
5232 @end deffn
5233
5234 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5235 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5236 script.
5237 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5238
5239 @itemize
5240 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5241 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5242 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5243 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5244 @end itemize
5245
5246 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5247 memory at address 0x20000000:
5248
5249 @example
5250 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5251 @end example
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5255 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5256 @command{$target_name configure}
5257 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5258 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5259 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5260 There are a few special cases:
5261
5262 @itemize @bullet
5263 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5264 event named @var{event_name}.
5265 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5266 two parameters.
5267 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5268 This is a special case because this is set using
5269 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5270 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5271 @end itemize
5272
5273 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5274 all the targets you might use something like this:
5275
5276 @example
5277 foreach name [target names] @{
5278 set y [$name cget -endian]
5279 set z [$name cget -type]
5280 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5281 $x $name $y $z]
5282 @}
5283 @end example
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5287 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5288 Displays the current target state:
5289 @code{debug-running},
5290 @code{halted},
5291 @code{reset},
5292 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5293 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5294 @end deffn
5295
5296 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5297 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5298 currently associated with this target.
5299 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5300 @end deffn
5301
5302 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5303 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5304 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5305 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5306 @end deffn
5307
5308 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5309 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5310 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5311 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5312 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5313 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5314 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5315 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5316 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5317 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5318 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5319 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5320 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5321 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5322 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5326 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5327 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5328 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5329 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5330 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5331 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5332 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5333 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5334 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5335 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5336 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5337 @end deffn
5338
5339 @anchor{targetevents}
5340 @section Target Events
5341 @cindex target events
5342 @cindex events
5343 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5344 For example:
5345 @itemize @bullet
5346 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5347 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5348 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5349 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5350 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5351 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5352 to set up system clocks or
5353 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5354 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5355 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5356 @end itemize
5357
5358 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5359 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5360 @command{target create ... -event}.
5361
5362 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5363 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5364 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5365
5366 @example
5367 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5368 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5369 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5370 @}
5371 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5372 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5373 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5374 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5375 @}
5376 @end example
5377
5378 The following target events are defined:
5379
5380 @itemize @bullet
5381 @item @b{debug-halted}
5382 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5383 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5384 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5385 @item @b{early-halted}
5386 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5387 @item @b{examine-start}
5388 @* Before target examine is called.
5389 @item @b{examine-end}
5390 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5391 @item @b{examine-fail}
5392 @* After target examine fails.
5393 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5394 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5395 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5396 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5397 connect GDB to running target.
5398 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5399 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5400 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5401 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5402 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5403 is in RAM or read only memory.
5404 Default is @code{halt}
5405 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5406 @* When GDB disconnects
5407 @item @b{gdb-end}
5408 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5409 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5410 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5411 @code{reset init})
5412 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5413 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5414 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5415 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5416 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5417 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5418 @item @b{gdb-start}
5419 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5420 @item @b{halted}
5421 @* The target has halted
5422 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5423 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5424 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5425 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5426 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5427 @item @b{reset-assert}
5428 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5429 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5430 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5431 it instead of asserting SRST.
5432 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5433 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5434 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5435 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5436 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5437 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5438 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5439 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5440 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5441 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5442 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5443 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5444 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5445 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5446 released on the scan chain.
5447 @item @b{reset-end}
5448 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5449 @item @b{reset-init}
5450 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5451 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5452
5453 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5454 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5455 multiplexing, and so on.
5456 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5457 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5458 @item @b{reset-start}
5459 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5460 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5461
5462 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5463 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5464 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5465 @item @b{resume-start}
5466 @* Before any target is resumed
5467 @item @b{resume-end}
5468 @* After all targets have resumed
5469 @item @b{resumed}
5470 @* Target has resumed
5471 @item @b{step-start}
5472 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5473 @item @b{step-end}
5474 @* After single-step has completed
5475 @item @b{trace-config}
5476 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5477 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5478 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5479 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5480 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5481 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5482 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5483 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5484 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5485 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5486 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5487 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5488 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5489 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5490 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5491 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5492 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5493 @end itemize
5494
5495 @quotation Note
5496 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5497 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5498 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5499 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5500 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5501 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5502 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5503 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5504 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5505 check if the core has changed status.
5506 @end quotation
5507
5508 @node Flash Commands
5509 @chapter Flash Commands
5510
5511 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5512 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5513 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5514 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5515 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5516 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5517 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5518 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5519 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5520
5521 Flash Steps:
5522 @enumerate
5523 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5524 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5525 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5526 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5527 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5528 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5529 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5530 @item GDB Flashing
5531 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5532 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5533 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5534 @end enumerate
5535
5536 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5537 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5538 so that it can't boot.
5539 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5540 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5541
5542 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5543 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5544 @cindex flash configuration
5545
5546 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5547 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5548 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5549 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5550 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5551 see the driver-specific documentation.
5552
5553 @itemize @bullet
5554 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5555 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5556 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5557 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5558 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5559 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5560 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5561 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5562 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5563 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5564 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5565 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5566 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5567 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5568 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5569 commands to the flash controller.
5570 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5571 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5572 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5573 for more information.
5574 @end itemize
5575 @quotation Note
5576 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5577 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5578 @end quotation
5579 @end deffn
5580
5581 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5582 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5583 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5584 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5585 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5586 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5590 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5591 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5592 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5596 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5597 depends on the flash type.
5598 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5599 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5600 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5601 but most don't bother.
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5605
5606 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5607 begins.
5608
5609 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5610 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5611 until the programming session is finished.
5612
5613 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5614 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5615
5616 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5617
5618 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5619 @cindex flash erasing
5620 @cindex flash reading
5621 @cindex flash writing
5622 @cindex flash programming
5623 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5624
5625 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5626 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5627 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5628 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5629 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5630
5631 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5632 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5633 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5634 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5635 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5636
5637 @quotation Note
5638 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5639 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5640 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5641 back to a flash bank.
5642 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5643 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5644 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5645 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5646 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5647 @end quotation
5648
5649 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5650 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5651 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5652 disabled first.
5653 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5654 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5655 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5656
5657 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5658 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5659 up to and including @var{last}.
5660 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5661 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5662 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5663 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5667 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5668 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5669 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5670 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5671 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5672 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5673 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5674 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5675 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5676 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5677 before erase starts.
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5681 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5682 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5683 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5684 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5685 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5686 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5687 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5688 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5689 before issuing this command.
5690 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5691 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5692 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5693 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5694 @end deffn
5695 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5696
5697 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5698 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5699 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5700 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5701 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5702 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5703 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5704 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5705 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5706 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5707 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5708 @end deffn
5709
5710 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5711 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5712 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5713 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5714 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5718 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5719 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5720 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5721 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5726 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5727 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5728 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5729 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5733 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5734 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5735 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5736 to the base address for each section in the image.
5737 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5738 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5739 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5740 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5741 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5742 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5743 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5744 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5745 each image section.
5746
5747 @quotation Warning
5748 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5749 data you want to preserve.
5750 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5751 sections might be erased with no notice.
5752 @itemize
5753 @item
5754 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5755 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5756 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5757 @item
5758 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5759 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5760 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5761 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5762 @end itemize
5763 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5764 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5765 @end quotation
5766
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5770 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5771 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5772 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5773 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5774 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5775 ordinary memory reads.
5776 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5777 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5778 check for successful programming.
5779 @end deffn
5780
5781 @section Other Flash commands
5782 @cindex flash protection
5783
5784 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5785 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5786 and display that status.
5787 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5788 @end deffn
5789
5790 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5791 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5792 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5793
5794 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5795 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5796 and possibly stale information.
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @anchor{flashprotect}
5800 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5801 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5802 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5803 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5804 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5805 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5806 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5807 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5808 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5809 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5810 @end deffn
5811
5812 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5813 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5814 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5815 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @anchor{program}
5819 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5820 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5821 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5822 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5823 @end deffn
5824
5825 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5826 @section Flash Driver List
5827 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5828 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5829 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5830
5831 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5832 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5833 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5834
5835 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5836
5837 @itemize
5838 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5839 @end itemize
5840
5841 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5842 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5843 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5844 @example
5845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5846 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5847 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5848 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5849 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5850 @end example
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @subsection External Flash
5854
5855 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5856 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5857 @cindex CFI
5858 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5859 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5860 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5861 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5862 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5863 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5864 configure a bus and its timings), or
5865 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5866 on the flash chip.
5867 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5868 speed up operation.
5869
5870 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5871
5872 @itemize
5873 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5874 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5875 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5876 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5877 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5878 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5879 @end itemize
5880
5881 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5882 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5883
5884 @example
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5887 @end example
5888
5889 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5890 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5891 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5892
5893 @example
5894 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5895 @end example
5896
5897 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5898 @end deffn
5899
5900 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5901 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5902 @cindex SPI
5903 @cindex jtagspi
5904 @cindex bscan_spi
5905 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5906 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5907 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5908 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5909 accessed through JTAG.
5910
5911 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5912 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5913 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5914 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5915 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5916 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5917
5918 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5919 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5920 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5921 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5922 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5923 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5924 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5925 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5926
5927 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5928 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5929 command, see below.
5930
5931 @itemize
5932 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5933 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5934 @var{USER1} instruction.
5935 @end itemize
5936
5937 @example
5938 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5939 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5941 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5942 @end example
5943
5944 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5945 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5946 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5947 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5948 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5949 @example
5950 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5951 @end example
5952 @end deffn
5953
5954 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5955 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5956 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5957 @example
5958 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5959 @end example
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5963 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5964 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5965 @end deffn
5966 @end deffn
5967
5968 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5969 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5970 @cindex xcf
5971 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5972 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5973 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5974 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5975 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5976
5977 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5978 command accepts additional parameters:
5979 @itemize
5980 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5981 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5982 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5983 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5984 in master mode.
5985 @end itemize
5986 @example
5987 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5988 @end example
5989 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5990 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5991 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5992 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5993 dedicated sector.
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5997 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5998 button.
5999 @example
6000 xcf configure 0
6001 @end example
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 Additional driver notes:
6005 @itemize
6006 @item Only single revision supported.
6007 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
6008 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
6009 (Intel hex) file types supported.
6010 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
6011 @end itemize
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
6015 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
6016 @cindex SPIFI
6017 @cindex lpcspifi
6018 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
6019 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
6020 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
6021
6022 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
6023 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
6024 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
6025 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
6026 significantly reduce flash programming times.
6027
6028 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
6029 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
6030 are configured by the driver.
6031
6032 @example
6033 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6034 @end example
6035
6036 @end deffn
6037
6038 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
6039 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
6040 @cindex SMI
6041 @cindex stmsmi
6042 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
6043 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6044 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6045 SPI flash devices.
6046 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6047 flash devices can be connected.
6048
6049 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6050 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6051 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6052 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6053 the flash content.
6054
6055 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6056 to identify the memory bank.
6057 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6058 flash size, are detected automatically.
6059
6060 @example
6061 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6062 @end example
6063
6064 @end deffn
6065
6066 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6067 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6068 @cindex QuadSPI
6069 @cindex OctoSPI
6070 @cindex stmqspi
6071 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6072 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6073 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6074 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6075 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6076 mode is not.
6077
6078 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6079 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6080 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6081 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6082
6083 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6084 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6085 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6086
6087 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6088 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6089 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6090 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6091 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6092 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6093
6094 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6095 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6096 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6097 should be avoided.
6098
6099 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6100 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6101 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6102 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6103 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6104 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6105
6106 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6107 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6108 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6109 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6110 persist across openocd invocations.
6111
6112 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6113 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6114 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6115 required (see 'set' command).
6116
6117 @example
6118 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6119 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6120 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6121 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6122 @end example
6123
6124 There are three specific commands
6125 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6126 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6127 chip specific write protection engaged.
6128 @end deffn
6129
6130 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6131 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6132 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6133 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6134 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6135 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6136
6137 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6138 which don't support an id command.
6139
6140 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6141 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6142 @end deffn
6143
6144 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6145 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6146 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6147 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6148 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6149
6150 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6151 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6152 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6153 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6154
6155 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6156
6157 To check basic communication settings, issue
6158 @example
6159 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6160 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6161 @end example
6162 for single flash mode or
6163 @example
6164 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6165 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6166 @end example
6167 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6168
6169 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6170 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6171 need a dummy address, e.g.
6172 @example
6173 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6174 @end example
6175 should return the status register contents.
6176
6177 @end deffn
6178
6179 @end deffn
6180
6181 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6182 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6183 Microcontroller platform.
6184
6185 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6186 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6187
6188 @example
6189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6190 @end example
6191
6192 @end deffn
6193
6194 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6195 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6196 @cindex ath79
6197 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6198 chip selects.
6199 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6200 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6201 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6202 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6203 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6204 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6205
6206 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6207 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6208 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6209 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6210 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6211 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6212 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6213 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6214 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6215 with the default CS0.
6216 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6217 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6218 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6219
6220 @example
6221 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6222
6223 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6224 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6225 # distinguish the banks.
6226 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6227 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6228 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6229 @end example
6230
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6234 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6235 @cindex fespi
6236
6237 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6238
6239 @example
6240 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6241 @end example
6242 @end deffn
6243
6244 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6245
6246 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6247 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6248 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6249 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6250 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6251 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6252
6253 @example
6254 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6255 @end example
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6259 @cindex ambiqmicro
6260 @cindex apollo
6261 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6262 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6263 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6264 with the target using SWD.
6265
6266 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6267 the device class of the MCU.
6268 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6269 to set up the flash banks.
6270 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6271 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6272
6273 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6274 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6275 and the second bank starts after the first.
6276
6277 @example
6278 # Flash bank 0
6279 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6280 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6282 $_TARGETNAME
6283 @end example
6284
6285 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6286 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6287 are available to the user.
6288
6289 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6290
6291 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6292 Erase entire bank.
6293 @end deffn
6294 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6295 Erase device pages.
6296 @end deffn
6297 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6298 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6299 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6300 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6301 the flash.
6302 @end deffn
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @anchor{at91samd}
6306 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6307 @cindex at91samd
6308 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6309 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6310
6311 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6312
6313 The devices have one flash bank:
6314
6315 @example
6316 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6317 @end example
6318
6319 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6320 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6321 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6322 processor to be halted.
6323 @end deffn
6324
6325 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6326 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6327 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6328 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6329 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6330 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6331
6332 @example
6333 at91samd set-security enable
6334 @end example
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6338 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6339 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6340 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6341 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6342 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6343 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6344 in order to disable this feature.
6345
6346 @example
6347 at91samd eeprom
6348 at91samd eeprom 1024
6349 @end example
6350 @end deffn
6351
6352 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6353 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6354 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6355 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6356 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6357 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6358
6359 @example
6360 at91samd bootloader
6361 at91samd bootloader 16384
6362 @end example
6363 @end deffn
6364
6365 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6366 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6367 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6368 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6372 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6373 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6374 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6375 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6376 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6377 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6378 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6379
6380 @example
6381 # Read user row
6382 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6383 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6384 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6385 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6386 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6387 # byte unchanged
6388 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6389 @end example
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @end deffn
6393
6394 @anchor{at91sam3}
6395 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6396 @cindex at91sam3
6397 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6398 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6399 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6400 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6401 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6402 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6403 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6404 chips are confirmed.}
6405
6406 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6407 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6408 the following fixed locations:
6409
6410 @example
6411 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6413 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6415 @end example
6416
6417 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6418 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6419 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6420
6421 @itemize
6422 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6423 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6424 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6425 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6426 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6427 @end itemize
6428
6429 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6430
6431 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6432 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6433 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6434 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6435 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6436 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6437 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6438
6439 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6440 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6444 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6445 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6446 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6447 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6448 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6449 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6450 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6454 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6455 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6456 @end deffn
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6460 @cindex at91sam4
6461 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6462 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6463 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6467 @cindex at91sam4l
6468 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6469 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6470 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6471
6472 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6473 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6474 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6475 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6476 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6477 @end deffn
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @anchor{atsame5}
6481 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6482 @cindex atsame5
6483 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6484 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6485 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6486
6487 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6488 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6489 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6490
6491 @example
6492 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6493 @end example
6494
6495 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6496 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6497 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6498 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6499 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6500 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6501
6502 @example
6503 atsame5 bootloader
6504 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6505 @end example
6506 @end deffn
6507
6508 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6509 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6510 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6511 processor to be halted.
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6515 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6516 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6517 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6521 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6522 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6523 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6524 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6525 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6526 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6527 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6528
6529 @example
6530 # Read
6531 >atsame5 userpage
6532 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6533 # Write
6534 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6535 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6536 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6537 # bytes)
6538 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6539 @end example
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @end deffn
6543
6544 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6545 @cindex atsamv
6546 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6547 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6548 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6549
6550 @example
6551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6552 @end example
6553
6554 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6555 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6556 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6557 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6558 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6559
6560 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6561 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6562 @end deffn
6563
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6567 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6568 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6569 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6570 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6571
6572 @example
6573 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6574 @end example
6575
6576 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6577 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6578
6579 @itemize
6580 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6581 @item @var{banks}
6582 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6583 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6584 @item @var{pages_size}
6585 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6586 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6587 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6588 @end itemize
6589
6590 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6591 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6592 will be autoconfigured.
6593 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6594
6595 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6596 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6597 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6598 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6599 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6600
6601 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6602 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6603 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6604 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6605 are not truly general purpose).
6606 @quotation Note
6607 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6608 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6609 @end quotation
6610 @end deffn
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6614 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6615 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6616 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6620 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6621 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6622 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6623
6624 @example
6625 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6626 @end example
6627
6628 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6629 each single sector one by one.
6630
6631 @example
6632 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6633 @end example
6634
6635 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6639 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6640 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6641 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6642 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6643 starts at address 0.
6644
6645 @example
6646 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6647 @end example
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6651 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6652 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6653 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6654 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6655 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6656 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6657 and programming the serial flash.
6658
6659 @example
6660 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6661 @end example
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6665 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6666 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6667 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6668 autoconfigures itself.
6669 @example
6670 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6671 @end example
6672 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6673 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6674 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6675 currently not supported.
6676 @example
6677 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6678 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6679 @end example
6680
6681 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6682 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6683 this via the following command:
6684 @example
6685 efm32 debuglock num
6686 @end example
6687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6688 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6689 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6690 supported.}
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6694 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6695 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6696 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6697 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6698 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6699
6700 @example
6701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6702 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6703 @end example
6704
6705 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6706 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6707 @end deffn
6708
6709 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6710 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6711 is an uncommon operation.}
6712 @end deffn
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6716 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6717 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6718 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6719 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6720 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6721 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6722
6723 @example
6724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6725 @end example
6726 @end deffn
6727
6728 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6729 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6730 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6731 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6732 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6733 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6734 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6735 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6736 characters) ignored.
6737
6738 @example
6739 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6740 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6741 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6742 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6743 @end example
6744 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6745 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6746 @end deffn
6747
6748 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6749 @cindex kinetis
6750 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6751 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6752 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6753 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6754 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6755 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6756
6757 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6758 @itemize
6759 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6760 @end itemize
6761
6762 @example
6763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6764 @end example
6765
6766 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6767 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6768 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6769 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6773 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6774 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6775 set by 'flash protect' command.
6776 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6777 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6778 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6779 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6780 with the rest of a flash image.
6781 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6782 @end deffn
6783
6784 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6785 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6786 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6790 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6791 and examine-fail event.
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6795 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6796 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6800 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6801 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6802 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6803 command completes.
6804 @end deffn
6805
6806 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6807 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6808 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6809 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6810 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6811
6812 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6813 Program Partition command.
6814
6815 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6816 Reset the device after partition setting.
6817
6818 Show partition size:
6819 @example
6820 kinetis nvm_partition info
6821 @end example
6822
6823 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6824 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6825 @example
6826 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6827 @end example
6828
6829 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6830 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6831 @example
6832 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6833 @end example
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6837 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6838 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6842 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6843 Command disables watchdog timer.
6844 @end deffn
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6848 @cindex kinetis_ke
6849 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6850 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6851 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6852 autoconfigures itself.
6853 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6854
6855 @example
6856 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6857 @end example
6858
6859 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6860 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6864 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6865 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6866 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6867 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6871 Command disables watchdog timer.
6872 @end deffn
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6876 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6877 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6878 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6879 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6880
6881 @quotation Note
6882 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6883 driver:
6884 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6885 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6886 @end quotation
6887
6888 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6889 which must appear in the following order:
6890
6891 @itemize
6892 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6893 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6894 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6895 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6896 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6897 LPC43x[2357])
6898 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6899 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6900 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6901 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6902 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6903 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6904 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6905 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6906 at which the core is running
6907 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6908 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6909 @quotation Note
6910 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6911 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6912 However, if you do provide it,
6913 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6914 @end quotation
6915 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6916 ROM IAP entry point.
6917 @end itemize
6918
6919 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6920
6921 @example
6922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6923 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6924 @end example
6925
6926 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6927 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6928 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6929 @end deffn
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6933 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6934 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6935 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6936 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6937 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6938
6939 @example
6940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6941 @end example
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6945 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6946 from NXP.
6947
6948 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6949 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6950 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6951 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6952 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6953 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6954 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6955 you start the PLL.
6956
6957 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6958
6959 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6960 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6961 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6962
6963 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6964 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6965 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6966 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6967 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6968 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6969 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6970
6971 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6972 @example
6973 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6974 @end example
6975
6976 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6977 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6978 @code{flash banks} command.
6979
6980 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6981 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6982 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6983 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6984 a known signature.
6985 Example:
6986 @example
6987 lpc2900 signature 0
6988 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6989 @end example
6990 @end deffn
6991
6992 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6993 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6994 saves it to a file in binary format.
6995 Example:
6996 @example
6997 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6998 @end example
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
7002 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
7003 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
7004 command:
7005
7006 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
7007 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
7008 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
7009 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
7010
7011 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
7012 Example:
7013 @example
7014 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
7015 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
7016 @end example
7017 @end deffn
7018
7019 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
7020 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
7021 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
7022 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
7023 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
7024 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
7025 912 bytes.
7026 @quotation Attention
7027 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7028 @end quotation
7029 Example:
7030 @example
7031 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
7032 @end example
7033 @end deffn
7034
7035 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
7036 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
7037 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
7038 after the next power cycle.
7039 @quotation Attention
7040 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7041 @end quotation
7042 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
7043 Example:
7044 @example
7045 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7046 flash info 0
7047 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7048 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7049 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7050 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7051 @end example
7052 @end deffn
7053
7054 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7055 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7056 effective after the next power cycle.
7057 @quotation Attention
7058 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7059 @end quotation
7060 Examples:
7061 @example
7062 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7063 @end example
7064 @end deffn
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7068 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7069 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7070 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7071
7072 @example
7073 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7074 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7075 @end example
7076
7077 @itemize @bullet
7078 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7079 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7080 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7081 @end itemize
7082
7083 Example usage:
7084 @example
7085 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7086 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7087 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7088 @} else @{
7089 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7090 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7091 @}
7092 @end example
7093 @end deffn
7094
7095 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7096 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7097 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7098 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7099 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7100 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7101
7102 @example
7103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7104 @end example
7105
7106 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7107 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7108 only the main program flash.
7109
7110 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7111 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7112 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7113 @end deffn
7114
7115 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7116 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7117 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7118 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7119
7120 To erase and program the BSL:
7121 @example
7122 msp432 bsl unlock
7123 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7124 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7125 msp432 bsl lock
7126 @end example
7127 @end deffn
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7131 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7132 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7133 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7134 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7135 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7136 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7137 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7138 also have division into regions: main and info.
7139 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7140 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7141
7142 @example
7143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7144 @end example
7145
7146 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7147
7148 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7149 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7153 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7154 @end deffn
7155
7156 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7157 Erase all userflash including info region.
7158 @end deffn
7159
7160 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7161 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7162 @end deffn
7163
7164 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7165 Check sectors protect.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7169 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7173 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7177 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7181 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7185 Show information about flash driver.
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7191 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7192 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7193 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7194 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7195
7196 @example
7197 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7198 @end example
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7202 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7203 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7204 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7205 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7206 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7207 - ACL).
7208
7209 @example
7210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7211 @end example
7212
7213 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7214
7215 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7216 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7217 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7218 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7219 code.
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7223 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7229 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7230 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7231
7232 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7233 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7234 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7235 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7236
7237 @example
7238 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7239 @end example
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7243 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7244 and integrate flash memory.
7245
7246 @example
7247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7248 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7249 @end example
7250
7251 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7252 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7253 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7254 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7255 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7256 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7257 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7258 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7259 @end deffn
7260 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7261 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7262 This will remove any Code Protection.
7263 @end deffn
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7267 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7268 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7269 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7270 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7271
7272 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7273 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7274
7275 @example
7276 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7277 @end example
7278
7279 psoc4-specific commands
7280 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7281 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7282
7283 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7284 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7285
7286 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7287 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7288 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7289
7290 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7294 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7295
7296 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7297 @end deffn
7298 @end deffn
7299
7300 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7301 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7302 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7303 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7304 apart from the base address.
7305
7306 @example
7307 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7308 @end example
7309
7310 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7311 @quotation Attention
7312 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7313 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7314 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7315 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7316 @end quotation
7317
7318 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7319
7320 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7321 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7322 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7323 @end deffn
7324 @end deffn
7325
7326 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7327 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7328 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7329 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7330 apart from the base address.
7331
7332 @example
7333 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7334 $_TARGETNAME
7335 @end example
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7339 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7340 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7341 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7342
7343 @example
7344 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7345 @end example
7346
7347 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7348
7349 @itemize
7350 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7351 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7352 @end itemize
7353
7354 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7355
7356 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7357 @quotation Attention
7358 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7359 after successful write.
7360 @end quotation
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7364 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7365 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7366 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7367
7368 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7369 @itemize @bullet
7370 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7371 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7372 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7373 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7374 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7375 row size: 512 bytes.
7376 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7377 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7378 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7379 operation will erase row automatically.
7380 @end itemize
7381
7382 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7383 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7384
7385 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7386
7387 @example
7388 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7389 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7390 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7391 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7392 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7393 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7394 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7395 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7396 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7397 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7398 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7399 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7400
7401 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7402 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7403 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7404 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7405 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7406 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7407 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7408 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7409 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7410 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7411 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7412 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7413 @end example
7414
7415 psoc6-specific commands
7416 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7417 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7418 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7419 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7420 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7421 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7425 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7426 by @command{flash banks}.
7427 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7428 @end deffn
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7432 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7433 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7434 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7435 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7436
7437 @example
7438 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7439 @end example
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7443 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7444 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7445 and SWD interface.
7446 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7447 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7448
7449 @example
7450 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7451 @end example
7452
7453 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7454
7455 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7456 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7457 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7461 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7462 @end deffn
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7466 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7467 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7468 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7469 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7470
7471 @example
7472 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7473 @end example
7474
7475 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7476 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7477 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7478 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7479 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7480 disabled.
7481
7482 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7483 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7484 @quotation Warning
7485 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7486 applied to all of them.
7487 @end quotation
7488 @end deffn
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7492 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7493 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7494 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7495 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7496 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7497 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7498
7499 @example
7500 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7501 @end example
7502
7503 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7504 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7505 the flash driver.
7506
7507 @example
7508 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7509 @end example
7510
7511 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7512 as per the following example.
7513 @example
7514 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7515 @end example
7516
7517 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7518
7519 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7520 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7521 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7525 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7526 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7527 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7531 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7532 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7536 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7537 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7538 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7539 @end deffn
7540
7541 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7542 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7543 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7544 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7548 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7549 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7550 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7551 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7552 @end deffn
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7556 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7557 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7558 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7559 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7560
7561 @example
7562 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7563 @end example
7564
7565 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7566 as per the following example.
7567 @example
7568 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7569 @end example
7570
7571 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7572 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7573 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7577 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7578 the flash driver.
7579
7580 @example
7581 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7582 @end example
7583
7584 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7585
7586 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7587 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7588 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7592 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7593 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7597 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7598 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7602 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7603 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7607 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7608 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7609 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7610 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7611 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7615 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7616 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7617 @end deffn
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7621 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7622 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7623 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7624 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7625
7626 @example
7627 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7628 @end example
7629
7630 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7631 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7632 the flash driver.
7633
7634 @example
7635 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7636 @end example
7637
7638 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7639
7640 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7641 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7642 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7646 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7647 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7651 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7656 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7657 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7658 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7659 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7660
7661 Example usage:
7662 @example
7663 # read OPTSR_CUR
7664 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7665 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7666 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7667 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7668 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7669 @end example
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7673 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7674 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7675 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7676 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7677 will be touched).
7678
7679 Example usage:
7680 @example
7681 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7682 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7683 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7684 @end example
7685 @end deffn
7686 @end deffn
7687
7688 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7689 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7690 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7691 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7692 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7693
7694 @example
7695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7696 @end example
7697
7698 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7699 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7700 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7701 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7702 second bank.
7703
7704 @example
7705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7706 @end example
7707
7708 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7709
7710 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7711 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7713 @end deffn
7714
7715 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7716 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7721 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7722 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7723 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7724 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7725 @end deffn
7726 @end deffn
7727
7728 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7729 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7730 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7731 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7732 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7733 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7734
7735 @example
7736 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7737 @end example
7738
7739 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7740 as per the following example.
7741 @example
7742 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7743 @end example
7744
7745 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7746 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7747 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7748 @end deffn
7749
7750 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7751 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7752 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7753 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7754
7755 @example
7756 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7757 @end example
7758
7759 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7760
7761 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7762 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7763 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7764
7765 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7769 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7770 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7771
7772 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7773 @end deffn
7774
7775 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7776 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7777 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7778 @end deffn
7779
7780 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7781 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7782 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7783 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7784
7785 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7786 @example
7787 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7788 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7789 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7790 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7791 @end example
7792
7793 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7794 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7798 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7799 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7800 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7801 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7802
7803 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7804
7805 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7806 @example
7807 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7808 @end example
7809
7810 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7811 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7812 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7816 List the protected areas using WRP.
7817 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7818 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7819 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7820
7821 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7822 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7823 in single or dual-banks mode.
7824 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7825 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7826
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7830 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7831 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7832 @end deffn
7833
7834 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7835 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7836 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7837 the TrustZone status.
7838 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7839 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7840 @end deffn
7841 @end deffn
7842
7843 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7844 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7845 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7846 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7847 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7848
7849 @example
7850 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7851 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7852 @end example
7853
7854 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7855 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7856 for the specified flash bank.
7857 @end deffn
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7861 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7862 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7863 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7864 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7865
7866 @example
7867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7868 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7869 @end example
7870
7871 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7872 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7873 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7874
7875 @itemize @bullet
7876 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7877 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7878 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7879 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7880 @end itemize
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7886 @cindex str9xpec
7887
7888 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7889 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7890 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7891 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7892
7893 Here is some background info to help
7894 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7895 the str9:
7896 @enumerate
7897 @item
7898 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7899 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7900 @item
7901 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7902 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7903 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7904 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7905 @end enumerate
7906
7907 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7908 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7909 configured for flash bank 0.
7910 @example
7911 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7912 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7913 adapter assert srst
7914 # turn off target polling
7915 poll off
7916 # disable str9 core
7917 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7918 # read option bytes
7919 str9xpec options_read 0
7920 # re-enable str9 core
7921 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7922 poll on
7923 reset halt
7924 @end example
7925 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7926 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7927 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7928 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7929
7930 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7931
7932 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7933 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7937 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7938 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7939 @end deffn
7940
7941 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7942 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7943 erase the device.
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7947 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7948 @end deffn
7949
7950 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7951 Configure str9 boot bank.
7952 @end deffn
7953
7954 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7955 Configure str9 lvd source.
7956 @end deffn
7957
7958 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7959 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7963 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7967 Read str9 option bytes.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7971 Write str9 option bytes.
7972 @end deffn
7973
7974 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7975 unlock str9 device.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7981 @cindex swm050
7982 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7983
7984 @example
7985 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7986 @end example
7987
7988 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7989
7990 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7991 Erases the entire flash bank.
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996
7997 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7998 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7999 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8000 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8001
8002 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
8003
8004 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
8005 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
8009 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
8010 @end deffn
8011
8012 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8013 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8014 the flash clock.
8015 @end deffn
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8019 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8020 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8021 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8022 correct bank config.
8023
8024 @example
8025 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8026 @end example
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8030 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8031 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8032 @end deffn
8033
8034 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8035 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8036 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8037
8038 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8039
8040 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8041 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8045 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8046 @end deffn
8047
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @section NAND Flash Commands
8051 @cindex NAND
8052
8053 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8054 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8055 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8056
8057 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8058 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8059 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8060 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8061 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8062 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8063
8064 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8065 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8066 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8067 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8068 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8069 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8070 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8071 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8072 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8073 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8074
8075 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8076 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8077 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8078 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8079 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8080 every 512 bytes of data.
8081
8082 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8083 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8084 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8085 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8086 ECC mode is used.
8087
8088 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8089 @enumerate
8090 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8091 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8092 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8093 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8094 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8095 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8096 to access that device.
8097 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8098 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8099 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8100 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8101 de-brick a board.
8102 @end enumerate
8103
8104 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8105 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8106 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8107 are only 32 bits wide.
8108 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8109 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8110 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8111 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8112
8113 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8114 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8115 @cindex NAND configuration
8116
8117 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8118 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8119 OpenOCD has initialized.
8120
8121 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8122 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8123 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8124 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8125 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8126 they were a single (larger) device.
8127 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8128 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8129
8130 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8131 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8132 configuration files, not interactively.
8133
8134 @itemize @bullet
8135 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8136 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8137 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8138 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8139 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8140 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8141 commands to the NAND controller.
8142 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8143 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8144 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8145 for more information.
8146 @end itemize
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8150 Prints a summary of each device declared
8151 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8152 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8153 @example
8154 > nand list
8155 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8156 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8157 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8158 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8159 >
8160 @end example
8161 @end deffn
8162
8163 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8164 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8165 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8166 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8167 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8168 it with most other NAND commands.
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8172
8173 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8174 @cindex NAND reading
8175 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8176 starting at the specified offset.
8177 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8178
8179 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8180 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8181
8182 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8183 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8184 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8185
8186 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8187 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8188 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8189 method which handled that error correction.
8190
8191 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8192 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8193 @itemize @bullet
8194 @item no oob_* parameter
8195 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8196 @item @code{oob_raw}
8197 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8198 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8199 spare areas associated with each data page.
8200 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8201 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8202 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8203 @item @code{oob_only}
8204 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8205 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8206 spare areas associated with each data page.
8207 @end itemize
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8211 @cindex NAND erasing
8212 @cindex NAND programming
8213 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8214 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8215 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8216 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8217 If those parameters are not specified,
8218 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8219 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8220
8221 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8222 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8223 block marker.
8224 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8225 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8226 @end deffn
8227
8228 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8229 @cindex NAND writing
8230 @cindex NAND programming
8231 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8232 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8233 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8234 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8235
8236 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8237 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8238
8239 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8240 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8241 past the end of the device.
8242 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8243 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8244 if that's being written.)
8245
8246 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8247 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8248 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8249
8250 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8251 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8252 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8253 @itemize @bullet
8254 @item no oob_* parameter
8255 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8256 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8257 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8258 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8259 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8260 @item @code{oob_only}
8261 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8262 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8263 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8264 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8265 @item @code{oob_raw}
8266 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8267 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8268 un-altered OOB.
8269 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8270 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8271 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8272 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8273 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8274 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8275 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8276 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8277 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8278 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8279 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8280 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8281 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8282 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8283 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8284 @end itemize
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8288 @cindex NAND verification
8289 @cindex NAND programming
8290 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8291 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8292 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8293
8294 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8295 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8296
8297 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8298 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8299 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8300 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8301 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8302
8303 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8304 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8305 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8306
8307 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8308 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8309 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8310 be removed in a future release.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @subsection Other NAND commands
8314 @cindex NAND other commands
8315
8316 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8317 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8318 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8319 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8320 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8321 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8322 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8323 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8324
8325 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8326 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8327 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8328 @end deffn
8329
8330 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8331 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8332 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8333 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8334 status for each block.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8338 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8339 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8340
8341 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8342 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8343 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8344 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8345 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8346
8347 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8348 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8349 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8350 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8351 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8352 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8353 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8354 @end deffn
8355
8356 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8357 @subsection NAND Driver List
8358 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8359 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8360 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8361
8362 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8363 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8364 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8365 address of the ECC controller.
8366 @example
8367 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8368 @end example
8369 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8370 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8371 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8372 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8373 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8374 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8375 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8376 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8377 @end deffn
8378 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8379 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8380 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8381 @end deffn
8382
8383 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8384 properly configured for input or output.
8385 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8386 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8387 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8388 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8389 @end deffn
8390 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8391 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8392 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8393 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8394 @end deffn
8395 @end deffn
8396
8397 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8398 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8399 chips from Texas Instruments.
8400 It takes three extra parameters:
8401 address of the NAND chip;
8402 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8403 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8404 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8405 @example
8406 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8407 @end example
8408 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8409 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8410 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8411 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8412 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8416 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8417 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8418 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8419 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8420 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8421 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8425 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8426 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8427 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8428 @end deffn
8429 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8430
8431 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8432 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8433 should work for this chip as well.
8434 @end deffn
8435
8436 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8437 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8438 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8439 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8440 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8441 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8442 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8443 @example
8444 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8445 @end example
8446 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8447 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8448 without parameter query status.
8449 @end deffn
8450 @end deffn
8451
8452 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8453 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8454 parameter: the address of the controller.
8455 @example
8456 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8457 @end example
8458 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8459 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8460 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8461 change any behavior.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8465 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8466 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8467 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8468 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8469 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8470 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8471 specialized commands.
8472 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8473 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8474 change any behavior.
8475 @end deffn
8476
8477 @node Flash Programming
8478 @chapter Flash Programming
8479
8480 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8481 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8482 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8483
8484 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8485 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8486
8487 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8488 @enumerate
8489 @item 'init' is executed.
8490 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8491 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8492 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8493 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8494 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8495 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8496 @end enumerate
8497
8498 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8499
8500 @example
8501 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8502 # are optional parameters
8503 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8504 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8505
8506 # binary files need the flash address passing
8507 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8508 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8509 @end example
8510
8511 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8512 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8513 @cindex PLD
8514 @cindex FPGA
8515
8516 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8517 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8518 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8519 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8520 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8521 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8522 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8523
8524 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8525
8526 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8527 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8528 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8529
8530 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8531 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8532
8533 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8534 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8535 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8536 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8537 behavior.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8541 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8545 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8546 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8550
8551 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8552 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8553 that particular type of PLD.
8554
8555 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8556 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8557 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8558
8559 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8560 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8561 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8562
8563 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8564 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8565 for FPGA @var{num}.
8566 @end deffn
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @node General Commands
8570 @chapter General Commands
8571 @cindex commands
8572
8573 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8574 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8575 commands are documented elsewhere.
8576
8577 Intent:
8578 @itemize @bullet
8579 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8580 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8581 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8582 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8583
8584 @item @b{From the human}
8585 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8586 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8587
8588 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8589 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8590 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8591
8592 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8593 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8594 port is 5555.
8595 @end itemize
8596
8597
8598 @section Server Commands
8599
8600 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8601 Exits the current telnet session.
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8605 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8606 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8607 Not every command provides helptext.
8608
8609 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8610 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8611 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8612 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8613 @end deffn
8614
8615 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8616 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8617 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8618 containing @var{string}.
8619 Not every command provides helptext.
8620 @end deffn
8621
8622 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8623 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8624 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8625 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8626 Useful in connection with script files
8627 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8628 @end deffn
8629
8630 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8631 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8632 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8633 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8634
8635 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8636 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8637
8638 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8639 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8640 @example
8641 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8642 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8643 @end example
8644 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8645 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8646 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8647 will proceed to quit.
8648 @end deffn
8649
8650 @anchor{debuglevel}
8651 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8652 @cindex message level
8653 Display debug level.
8654 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8655 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8656 Level 0 is error messages only;
8657 level 1 adds warnings;
8658 level 2 adds informational messages;
8659 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8660 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8661 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8662 the command line along with the location of that log
8663 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8664 @xref{Running}.
8665 @end deffn
8666
8667 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8668 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8669 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8670 @example
8671 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8672 @end example
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8676 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8677 the default log output channel is stderr.
8678 @end deffn
8679
8680 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8681 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8682 @end deffn
8683
8684 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8685 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8686 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8687 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8688 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8689 @end deffn
8690
8691 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8692 @section Target State handling
8693 @cindex reset
8694 @cindex halt
8695 @cindex target initialization
8696
8697 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8698 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8699 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8700 a current target which is used to perform the
8701 various operations. The current target may be changed
8702 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8703 target which should become current.
8704
8705 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8706 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8707 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8708 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8709 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8710
8711 @emph{With no arguments}:
8712 list all available registers for the current target,
8713 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8714 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8715 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8716 are flagged as such.
8717
8718 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8719 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8720 bypassing any internal cache.
8721
8722 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8723 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8724 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8725 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8726 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8727 relevant module will flush such values.
8728
8729 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8730 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8731
8732 @example
8733 > reg
8734 ===== ARM registers
8735 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8736 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8737 (2) r2 (/32)
8738 ...
8739 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8740 >
8741 @end example
8742 @end deffn
8743
8744 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8745 Set register values of the target.
8746
8747 @itemize
8748 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8749 @end itemize
8750
8751 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8752 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8753
8754 @example
8755 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8756 @end example
8757 @end deffn
8758
8759 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8760 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8761 of register names and values.
8762 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8763 target, bypassing any caching.
8764
8765 @itemize
8766 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8767 @end itemize
8768
8769 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8770 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8771
8772 @example
8773 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8774 @end example
8775 @end deffn
8776
8777 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8778 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8779 script.
8780
8781 @itemize
8782 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8783 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8784 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8785 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8786 @end itemize
8787
8788 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8789 memory at address 0x20000000:
8790
8791 @example
8792 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8793 @end example
8794 @end deffn
8795
8796 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8797 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8798 script.
8799 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8800
8801 @itemize
8802 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8803 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8804 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8805 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8806 @end itemize
8807
8808 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8809 memory at address 0x20000000:
8810
8811 @example
8812 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8813 @end example
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8817 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8818 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8819 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8820 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8821 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8822 (and enter debug mode).
8823 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8824
8825 @quotation Warning
8826 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8827 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8828 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8829 power mode by gating the core clock;
8830 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8831
8832 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8833 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8834 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8835 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8836 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8837 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8838
8839 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8840 work with a JTAG debugger.
8841 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8842 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8843 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8844 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8845 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8846 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8847 @end quotation
8848
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8852 Resume the target at its current code position,
8853 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8854 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8858 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8859 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8860 @end deffn
8861
8862 @anchor{resetcommand}
8863 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8864 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8865 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8866 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8867 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8868 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8869 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8870
8871 The optional parameter specifies what should
8872 happen after the reset.
8873 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8874 The other options will not work on all systems.
8875 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8876
8877 @itemize @minus
8878 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8879 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8880 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8881 @end itemize
8882 @end deffn
8883
8884 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8885 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8886 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8887 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8888 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8889 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8890 state.
8891 @end deffn
8892
8893 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8894 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8895 Set values of reset signals.
8896 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8897 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8898 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8899 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8900
8901 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8902 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8903 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8904 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8905 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8906 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8907 the signal will not be modified.
8908
8909 @quotation Note
8910 TRST is specially handled.
8911 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8912 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8913 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8914 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8915 instead of the TRST signal.
8916 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8917 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8918 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8919 with handlers for that event.
8920 @end quotation
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8924 @section Memory access commands
8925 @cindex memory access
8926
8927 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8928 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8929 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8930 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8931
8932 @enumerate
8933 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8934 to change the current target.
8935 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8936 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8937 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8938 @end enumerate
8939
8940 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8941 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8942 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8943 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8944 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8945 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8946 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8947 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8948 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8949 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8950 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8951 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8952 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8953 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
8954 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8958 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8959 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8960 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8961 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8962 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8963 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8964 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8965 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8966 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8967 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8968 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @anchor{imageaccess}
8972 @section Image loading commands
8973 @cindex image loading
8974 @cindex image dumping
8975
8976 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8977 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8978 binary file named @var{filename}.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8982 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8983 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8984 @end deffn
8985
8986 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8987 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8988 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8989 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8990 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8991 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8992 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8993 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8994 separately.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8998 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8999 The file format may optionally be specified
9000 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
9001 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
9002 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
9003 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
9004 @example
9005 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
9006 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
9007 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
9008 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
9009 $address $length
9010 @}
9011 @end example
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9015 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9016 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9017 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9018 The file format may optionally be specified
9019 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9023 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9024 The file format may optionally be specified
9025 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9026 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9027 @end deffn
9028
9029 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9030 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9031 The file format may optionally be specified
9032 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9033 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036
9037 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9038 @cindex breakpoint
9039 @cindex watchpoint
9040
9041 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9042 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9043 watchpoints.
9044 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9045
9046 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9047 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9048 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9049 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9050 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9051 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9052
9053 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9054 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9055 @end deffn
9056
9057 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9058 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
9062 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
9063 @end deffn
9064
9065 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9066 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9067 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9068 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9069 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9070 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9071 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9072 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9073 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9074 @end deffn
9075
9076
9077 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9078
9079 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9080 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9081 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9082 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9083 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9084 running, can be used.
9085 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9086 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9087 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9088
9089 @quotation Note
9090 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9091 @end quotation
9092
9093 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9094 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9095 communication, respectively.
9096
9097 @quotation Note
9098 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9099 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9100 example.
9101 @end quotation
9102
9103 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9104 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9105 of TCP/IP connections.
9106
9107 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9108 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9109 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9110 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9111 @var{size} bytes.
9112 @end deffn
9113
9114 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9115 Start RTT.
9116 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9117 @end deffn
9118
9119 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9120 Stop RTT.
9121 @end deffn
9122
9123 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9124 Display the polling interval.
9125 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9126 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9127 checked for new data.
9128 @end deffn
9129
9130 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9131 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9135 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9136 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9140 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9144 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9145 @end deffn
9146
9147 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9148 on the target device.
9149
9150 @example
9151 resume
9152
9153 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9154 rtt start
9155
9156 rtt server start 9090 0
9157 @end example
9158
9159 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9160 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9161 TCP/IP port 9090.
9162
9163
9164 @section Misc Commands
9165
9166 @cindex profiling
9167 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9168 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9169 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9170 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9171 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9172 limit the address range.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @deffn {Command} {version}
9176 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9180 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9181 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9185 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9189 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9193 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9194 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9195 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9196
9197 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9198 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9199 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9200 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9201
9202 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9203 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9204 @cindex tracing
9205 @cindex ETM
9206 @cindex ETB
9207
9208 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9209 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9210 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9211
9212 @itemize
9213 @item
9214 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9215 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9216 supports such an interface.
9217 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9218 and trace port support.)
9219 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9220 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9221 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9222 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9223 in the board-specific configuration file.
9224 @item
9225 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9226 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9227 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9228 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9229 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9230 @end itemize
9231
9232 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9233
9234 @quotation Issues
9235 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9236 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9237
9238 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9239 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9240 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9241 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9242 dummy trace port driver}.
9243
9244 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9245 as well as tracing only during specific states
9246 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9247
9248 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9249 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9250 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9251 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9252 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9253
9254 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9255 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9256 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9257 this original style of JTAG access.
9258 @end quotation
9259
9260 @subsection ETM Configuration
9261 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9262
9263 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9264 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9265 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9266
9267 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9268 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9269 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9270 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9271 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9272 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9273 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9274 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9275 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9276
9277 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9278 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9279 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9280
9281 @quotation Warning
9282 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9283 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9284 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9285 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9286 @end quotation
9287
9288 @quotation Note
9289 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9290 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9291 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9292 what CPU activities are traced.
9293 @end quotation
9294 @end deffn
9295
9296 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9297 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9298 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9299 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9300 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9304 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9305 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9306 Did trace data overflow?
9307 Was it triggered?
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9311 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9312 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9313 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9314 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9315
9316 @itemize
9317 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9318 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9319 The value is one of
9320 @option{none} (save nothing),
9321 @option{data} (save data),
9322 @option{address} (save addresses),
9323 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9324 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9325 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9326 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9327 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9328 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9329 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9330 trace stream without an image of the code.
9331 @end itemize
9332 @end deffn
9333
9334 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9335 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9336 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9337 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9338 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9339
9340 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9341 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9342 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9343 @end deffn
9344
9345 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9346
9347 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9348 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9349 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9350
9351 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9352 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9353 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9354 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9355 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9356 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9357 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9358
9359 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9360
9361 @itemize
9362 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9363 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9364 for instruction access within that function's body.
9365 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9366 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9367 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9368 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9369 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9370 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9371 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9372 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9373 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9374 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9375 @item @emph{... more}
9376 @end itemize
9377
9378 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9379 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9380
9381 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9382 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9383 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9384 @end deffn
9385
9386 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9387 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9391 Opens an image file.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9395 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9399 Starts trace data collection.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9403 Stops trace data collection.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9407 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9408
9409 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9410
9411 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9412 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9413 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9414 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9415 any trace data collection.}
9416 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9417 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9418 @end deffn
9419 @end deffn
9420
9421 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9422 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9423 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9424 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9425 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9426 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9427 @end deffn
9428 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9429 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9430 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9431 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9432 trace trigger becomes active.
9433
9434 @itemize
9435 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9436 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9437 afterwards.
9438 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9439 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9440 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9441 what caused that event to happen.
9442 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9443 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9444 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9445 how the event caused trouble.
9446 @end itemize
9447 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9448 @end deffn
9449
9450 @end deffn
9451
9452 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9453 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9454 @cindex CTI
9455
9456 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9457 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9458 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9459 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9460 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9461 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9462
9463 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9464 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9465 @var{apn}.
9466 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9467 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9468 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9469 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9470 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9471 including additional configuration.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9475 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9479 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9483 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9487 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9491 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9495 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9496 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9497 @end deffn
9498
9499 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9500 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9501 of the CTI.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9505 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9506 useful in TCL scripting.
9507 @end deffn
9508
9509 @section Generic ARM
9510 @cindex ARM
9511
9512 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9513 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9514 commands that may be available.
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9517 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9518 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9519 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9520 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9521 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9525 @cindex disassemble
9526 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9527 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9528 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9529 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9530 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9531 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9532 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9533
9534 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9535 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9536 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9537 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9538 with a handful of exceptions.
9539 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9540 @end deffn
9541
9542 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9543 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9544 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9545 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9546 and using the MCR instruction.
9547 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9548 an ARM register.)
9549 @end deffn
9550
9551 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9552 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9553 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9554 and the MRC instruction.
9555 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9556 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9557 an ARM register.)
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9561 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9562 core mode if necessary.
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9566 @cindex ARM semihosting
9567 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9568
9569 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9570 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9571 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9572 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9573 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9574 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9575 @end deffn
9576
9577 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port>
9578 [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all})
9579 @cindex ARM semihosting
9580 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9581
9582 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9583 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9584 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9585 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9586 @end deffn
9587
9588 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9589 @cindex ARM semihosting
9590 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9591
9592 @example
9593 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9594 @end example
9595
9596 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9597 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9598 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9599 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9603 @cindex ARM semihosting
9604 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9605 status.
9606
9607 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9608 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9609 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9610 debugger.
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9614 @cindex ARM semihosting
9615 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9616
9617 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9618 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9619 the value returned by the target.
9620
9621 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9622 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9623 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9624 encountering a break.
9625
9626 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9627 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9628 to the debugger.
9629 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9630 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9631 request or equivalent").
9632
9633 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9634 this option (default: disabled).
9635 @end deffn
9636
9637 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9638 @cindex ARM semihosting
9639 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9640 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9641
9642 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9643 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9644 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9645 command.
9646 @end deffn
9647
9648 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9649 @cindex ARM semihosting
9650 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9651 Use "." for the current directory.
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9655 @cindex ARMv4
9656 @cindex ARMv5
9657
9658 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9659 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9660 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9661 variant.
9662
9663 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9664 @cindex ARM7
9665 @cindex ARM9
9666
9667 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9668 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9669 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9670 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9671
9672 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9673 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9674 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9675 instead of breakpoints.
9676 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9677
9678 This should be
9679 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9680 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9681 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9682 @end deffn
9683
9684 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9685 @cindex DCC
9686 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9687 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9688 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9689
9690 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9691 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9692 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9693 @end deffn
9694
9695 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9696 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9697 that don't check completion of the operation.
9698 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9699
9700 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9701 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9702 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9703 @end deffn
9704
9705 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9706 @cindex ARM9
9707
9708 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9709 integer processors.
9710 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9711
9712 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9713 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9714 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9715 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9716
9717 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9718 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9719 @cindex vector_catch
9720 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9721 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9722 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9723 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9724 to those hardware vectors.
9725
9726 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9727 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9728 vector catch hardware to intercept
9729 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9730 @option{none} of them,
9731 or a list with one or more of the following:
9732 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9733 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9734 @end deffn
9735
9736 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9737 @cindex ARM920T
9738
9739 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9740 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9741 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9742 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9743 and ARM9 commands.
9744
9745 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9746 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9747 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9748 @end deffn
9749
9750 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9751 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9752 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9753 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9754 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9755 (Not all registers can be written.)
9756 @end deffn
9757
9758 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9759 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9760 @end deffn
9761
9762 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9763 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9764 @end deffn
9765
9766 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9767 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9768
9769 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9770 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9771 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9772 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9773 and ARM9 commands.
9774
9775 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9776 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9777
9778 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9779 Print information about the caches found.
9780 @end deffn
9781
9782 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9783 @cindex ARM966E
9784
9785 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9786 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9787 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9788 and ARM9 commands.
9789
9790 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9791 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9792 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9793 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9794 ARM966E-S TRM.
9795 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9796 as required for BIST support.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @subsection XScale specific commands
9800 @cindex XScale
9801
9802 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9803
9804 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9805 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9806 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9807 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9808 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9809 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9810 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9811
9812 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9813 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9814 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9815 the mini-IC.
9816
9817 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9818 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9819 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9820 code layout in memory:
9821 @example
9822 _vectors:
9823 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9824 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9825 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9826 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9827 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9828 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9829 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9830 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9831 .org 0x100
9832 .long real_reset_vector
9833 .long real_ui_handler
9834 .long real_swi_handler
9835 .long real_pf_abort
9836 .long real_data_abort
9837 .long 0 /* unused */
9838 .long real_irq_handler
9839 .long real_fiq_handler
9840 @end example
9841
9842 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9843 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9844 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9845 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9846 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9847 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9848 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9849 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9850 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9851 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9852 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9853 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9854 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9855 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9856 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9857 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9858 software.
9859
9860 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9861 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9862 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9863 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9864
9865 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9866 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9867 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9868 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9869 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9870 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9871 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9872 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9873 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9874
9875 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9876 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9877
9878 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9879 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9883 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9884 @end deffn
9885
9886 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9887 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9891 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9892 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9896 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9900 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9901 @end deffn
9902
9903 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9904 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9905 @end deffn
9906
9907 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9908 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9909 @end deffn
9910
9911 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9912 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9916 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9917 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9918 and modifying how it is emptied.
9919 @end deffn
9920
9921 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9922 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9923 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9924 The image @var{type} may be one of
9925 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9926 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9927 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9928 @end deffn
9929
9930 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9931 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9932 @cindex vector_catch
9933 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9934 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9935
9936 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9937 @example
9938 0x01 Trap Reset
9939 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9940 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9941 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9942 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9943 0x20 reserved
9944 0x40 Trap IRQ
9945 0x80 Trap FIQ
9946 @end example
9947 @end deffn
9948
9949 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9950 @cindex vector_table
9951
9952 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9953 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9954 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9955 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9956 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9957
9958 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9959
9960 @end deffn
9961
9962 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9963 @cindex ARMv6
9964
9965 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9966 @cindex ARM11
9967
9968 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9969 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9970 which is enabled by default.
9971 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9972 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9973 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9974 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9975 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9976 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9977 @end deffn
9978
9979 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9980 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9981 which is enabled by default.
9982 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9983 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9984 @end deffn
9985
9986 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9987 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9988 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9989 they are disabled by default.
9990 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9991 @end deffn
9992
9993 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9994 @cindex vector_catch
9995 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9996 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9997 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9998
9999 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10000 for certain hardware events.
10001 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
10002 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
10003 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
10004 @end deffn
10005
10006 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
10007 @cindex ARMv7
10008 @cindex ARMv8
10009
10010 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
10011 @cindex Cortex-A
10012
10013 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
10014 display information about target caches
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10018 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10019 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10020 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10021 Defaults to 'off'.
10022 @end deffn
10023
10024 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10025 Initialize core debug
10026 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10027 @end deffn
10028
10029 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10030 Display/set the current SMP mode
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10034 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10035 @end deffn
10036
10037 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10038 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10039 @end deffn
10040
10041 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10042 configure l2x cache
10043 @end deffn
10044
10045 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10046 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10047 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10048 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10049 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10053 @cindex Cortex-R
10054
10055 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10056 Initialize core debug
10057 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10061 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064
10065 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10066 @cindex tracing
10067 @cindex SWO
10068 @cindex SWV
10069 @cindex TPIU
10070
10071 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10072 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10073 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10074 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10075
10076 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10077 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10078 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10079 which causes quite some confusion.
10080 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10081 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10082
10083 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10084 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10085 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10086
10087 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10088 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10089 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10093 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10094 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10095 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10096
10097 @itemize @bullet
10098 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10099 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10100 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10101 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10102
10103 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10104 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10105 @end itemize
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10109 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10110 @end deffn
10111
10112 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10113 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10114 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10115 at any time after the initialization, too.
10116 @end deffn
10117
10118 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10119 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10120 individually queried, to return its current value.
10121 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10122 @end deffn
10123
10124 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10125 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10126 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10127 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10128
10129 @itemize @bullet
10130 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10131 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10132
10133 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10134 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10135 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10136
10137 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10138 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10139
10140 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10141 protocol used for trace data:
10142 @itemize @minus
10143 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10144 data bits (default);
10145 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10146 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10147 @end itemize
10148
10149 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10150 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10151 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10152 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10153 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10154 of the TPIU.
10155
10156 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10157 the destination of the trace data:
10158 @itemize @minus
10159 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10160 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10161 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10162 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10163 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10164 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10165 each connected client;
10166 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10167 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10168 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10169 @end itemize
10170
10171 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10172 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10173 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10174 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10175
10176 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10177 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10178 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10179 maximum supported rate automatically.
10180
10181 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10182 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10183 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10184
10185 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10186 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10187 default value is @var{0}.
10188 @end itemize
10189 @end deffn
10190
10191 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10192 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10193 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10194 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10195 data.
10196 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10197 after the @command{init}.
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10201 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204
10205
10206 Example usage:
10207 @enumerate
10208 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10209 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10210 enough to:
10211 @example
10212 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10213 ...
10214 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10215 ...
10216 @end example
10217 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10218 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10219 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10220 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10221 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10222 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10223 @example
10224 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10225 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10226 @end example
10227 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10228 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10229 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10230 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10231 @example
10232 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10233 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10234 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10235 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10236 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10237 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10238 @end example
10239 @end enumerate
10240
10241 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10242 @cindex tracing
10243 @cindex SWO
10244 @cindex SWV
10245 @cindex ITM
10246 @cindex ETM
10247
10248 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10249 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10250 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10251 @end deffn
10252
10253 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10254 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10255 @end deffn
10256
10257 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10258 @cindex Cortex-M
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10261 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10262
10263 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10264 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10265 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10266 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10267 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10268 the step command leaves with the core running.
10269
10270 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10271 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10272 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10273 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10274
10275 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10276 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10277 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10278 does.
10279
10280 Default is @option{auto}.
10281 @end deffn
10282
10283 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10284 @cindex vector_catch
10285 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10286 for certain hardware events.
10287
10288 Parameters request interception of
10289 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10290 @option{none} of them,
10291 or one or more of the following:
10292 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10293 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10294 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10295 @option{irq_err},
10296 @option{state_err},
10297 @option{chk_err}, or
10298 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10299 @option{reset}.
10300 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10301 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10302 are mapped to HardFault.
10303 UsageFault checks for
10304 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10305 must also be explicitly enabled.
10306
10307 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10308 @end deffn
10309
10310 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10311 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10312 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10313
10314 @itemize @minus
10315 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10316 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10317 @end itemize
10318
10319 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10320 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10321 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10322 to manually reset the peripherals.
10323 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10324
10325 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10326 instead.
10327 @end deffn
10328
10329 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10330 @cindex ARMv8-A
10331 @cindex aarch64
10332
10333 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10334 Display information about target caches
10335 @end deffn
10336
10337 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10338 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10339 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10340 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10341 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10342 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10343 @end deffn
10344
10345 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10346 @cindex disassemble
10347 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10348 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10349 @end deffn
10350
10351 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10352 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10353 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10354 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10355 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10356 @end deffn
10357
10358 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10359 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10360 @option{on}.
10361 @end deffn
10362
10363 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10364 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10365 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10366 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10367 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10368 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10372
10373 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10374 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10375
10376 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10377
10378 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10379 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10380 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10381 @end deffn
10382
10383 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10384 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10385 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10386 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10387 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10388 @end deffn
10389
10390 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10391
10392 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10393 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10394 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10395 @end deffn
10396
10397 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10398
10399 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10400 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10401 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10402 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10403 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10404 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10405 can be collected.
10406
10407 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10408 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10409 tooling.
10410
10411 @quotation Issues
10412 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10413 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10414 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10415 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10416
10417 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10418 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10419 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10420 software operation on the CPU.
10421 @end quotation
10422
10423 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10424 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10425 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10426 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10427 @end deffn
10428
10429 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10430 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10431 @end deffn
10432
10433 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10434 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10435 control is disabled.
10436 @end deffn
10437
10438 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10439 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10440 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10441 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10442
10443 Supported trace formats:
10444 @itemize
10445 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10446 timing to be determined.
10447 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10448 addresses.
10449 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10450 @end itemize
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10454 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10455 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10456 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10457
10458 Supported conditions:
10459 @itemize
10460 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10461 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10462 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10463 instruction matches start data and mask.
10464 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10465 instruction matches start data and mask.
10466 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10467 data and mask.
10468 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10469 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10470 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10471 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10472 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10473 @end itemize
10474 @end deffn
10475
10476 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10477 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10478 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10479 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10480
10481 Supported conditions:
10482 @itemize
10483 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10484 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10485 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10486 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10487 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10488 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10489 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10490 data and mask.
10491 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10492 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10493 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10494 @end itemize
10495 @end deffn
10496
10497 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10498 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10499
10500 Supported triggers:
10501 @itemize
10502 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10503 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10504 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10505 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10506 collection.
10507 @end itemize
10508 @end deffn
10509
10510 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10511
10512 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10513 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10514 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10515 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10516 @end deffn
10517
10518 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10519 Display trace configuration.
10520 @end deffn
10521
10522 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10523 Display trace collection status.
10524 @end deffn
10525
10526 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10527 Start manual trace collection.
10528 @end deffn
10529
10530 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10531 Stop manual trace collection.
10532 @end deffn
10533
10534 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10535 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10536 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10537 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10538 @option{size} options using DMA.
10539 @end deffn
10540
10541 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10542 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10543 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10544 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10545 @option{size} options using DMA.
10546 @end deffn
10547
10548 @section Intel Architecture
10549
10550 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10551 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10552 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10553 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10554 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10555 @itemize
10556 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10557 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10558 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10559 @end itemize
10560
10561 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10562 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10563 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10564
10565 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10566 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10567 @end deffn
10568
10569 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10570 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10571 @end deffn
10572
10573 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10574 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10575 @end deffn
10576
10577 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10578 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10579 @end deffn
10580
10581 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10582 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10583 @end deffn
10584
10585 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10586 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10587 @end deffn
10588
10589 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10590
10591 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10592 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10593
10594 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10595 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10596 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10597 @end deffn
10598 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10599 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10600
10601 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10602
10603 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10604 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10605 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10606 @end deffn
10607
10608 @subsection Registers commands
10609 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10610 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10611 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10612
10613 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10614
10615 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10616 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10617 and "timer" groups.
10618
10619 @emph{example:}
10620 @example
10621 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10622 @end example
10623
10624 @end deffn
10625
10626 @section RISC-V Architecture
10627
10628 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10629 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10630 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10631 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10632 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10633 implement version 0.11.
10634
10635 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10636
10637 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10638 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10639 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10640
10641 @subsection Vector Registers
10642
10643 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10644 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10645 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10646 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10647 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10648 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10649 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10650 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10651 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10652
10653 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10654 follows:
10655
10656 @example
10657 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10658 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10659 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10660 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10661 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10662 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10663 <union id="riscv_vector">
10664 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10665 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10666 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10667 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10668 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10669 </union>
10670 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10671 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10672 ...
10673 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10674 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10675 </feature>
10676 @end example
10677
10678 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10679
10680 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10681 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10682 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10683 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10684 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10685 named @code{csr<n>}.
10686
10687 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10688 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10689 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10690 CSRs.
10691
10692 @example
10693 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10694 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10695
10696 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10697 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10698
10699 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10700 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10701 @end example
10702 @end deffn
10703
10704 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10705 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10706 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10707 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10708 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10709 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10710 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10711 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10712
10713 @example
10714 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10715 # under the name "custom16":
10716 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10717
10718 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10719 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10720 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10721
10722 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10723 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10724 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10725 @end example
10726 @end deffn
10727
10728 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10729 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10730 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10731 @end deffn
10732
10733 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10734 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10735 deasserted.
10736 @end deffn
10737
10738 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10739 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10740 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10741 @end deffn
10742
10743 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10744 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10745 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10746
10747 Available methods are:
10748 @itemize
10749 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10750 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10751 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10752 @end itemize
10753
10754 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10755 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10756
10757 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10758 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10759 @end deffn
10760
10761 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10762 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10763 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10764 on physical memory.
10765 @end deffn
10766
10767 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10768 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10769 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10770 performed on physical memory.
10771 @end deffn
10772
10773 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10774 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10775 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10776 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10777 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10778 race condition problem in your code.
10779
10780 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10781 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10782 @end deffn
10783
10784 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10785 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10786 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10787 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10788 values.
10789
10790 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10791 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10792 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10793 @end deffn
10794
10795 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10796 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10797 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10798 @end deffn
10799
10800 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10801 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10802 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10803 @end deffn
10804
10805 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10806 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10807 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10808 @end deffn
10809
10810 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10811 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10812 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10813 @end deffn
10814
10815 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10816
10817 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10818 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10819 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10820 @example
10821 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10822 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10823 @end example
10824
10825 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10826 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10827 @end deffn
10828
10829 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10830 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10831 @end deffn
10832
10833 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10834
10835 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10836 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10837
10838 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10839 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10840 @end deffn
10841
10842 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10843 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10844 @end deffn
10845
10846 @section ARC Architecture
10847 @cindex ARC
10848
10849 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10850 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10851 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10852 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10853 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10854 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10855 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10856 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10857 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10858 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10859 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10860 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10861 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10862 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10863 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10864
10865
10866 @subsection General ARC commands
10867
10868 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10869
10870 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10871 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10872 arguments:
10873
10874 @itemize @bullet
10875
10876 @item @code{-name} name
10877 @*Name of a register.
10878
10879 @item @code{-num} number
10880 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10881
10882 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10883 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10884
10885 @end itemize
10886
10887 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10888
10889 @itemize @bullet
10890
10891 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10892 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10893 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10894 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10895 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10896 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10897
10898 @item @code{-core}
10899 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10900 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10901 spaces.
10902
10903 @item @code{-bcr}
10904 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10905 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10906 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10907 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10908 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10909
10910 @item @code{-type} type_name
10911 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10912 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10913
10914 @item @code{-g}
10915 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10916 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10917 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10918 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10919 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10920
10921 @end itemize
10922
10923 @end deffn
10924
10925 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10926 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10927 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10928 @end deffn
10929
10930 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10931 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10932 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10933 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10934 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10935 startbit endbit}.
10936 @end deffn
10937
10938 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10939 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10940 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10941 @end deffn
10942
10943 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10944 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10945 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10946 @end deffn
10947
10948 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10949
10950 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10951 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10952 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10953 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10954
10955 @end deffn
10956
10957 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10958 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10959 registers.
10960 @end deffn
10961
10962 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10963 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10964 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10965 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10966
10967 @end deffn
10968
10969 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10970 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10971 registers.
10972 @end deffn
10973
10974 @section STM8 Architecture
10975 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10976 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10977
10978 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10979 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10980
10981 @section Xtensa Architecture
10982 Xtensa processors are based on a modular, highly flexible 32-bit RISC architecture
10983 that can easily scale from a tiny, cache-less controller or task engine to a high-performance
10984 SIMD/VLIW DSP provided by Cadence.
10985 @url{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip/tensilica-xtensa-controllers-and-extensible-processors.html}.
10986
10987 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processors implementation which can be customized by
10988 simply providing vendor-specific core configuration which controls every configurable
10989 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
10990 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. Also OpenOCD supports SMP
10991 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows to configure
10992 their debug signals interconnection (so-called "break/stall networks") which control how
10993 debug signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
10994 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). For debugging code on Xtensa chips OpenOCD
10995 uses JTAG protocol. Currently OpenOCD implements several Epsressif Xtensa-based chips of
10996 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
10997
10998 @subsection General Xtensa Commands
10999
11000 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11001 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11002 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11003 @end deffn
11004
11005 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (on|off)
11006 Selects whether interrupts will be disabled during stepping over single instruction. The default configuration is (off).
11007 @end deffn
11008
11009 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11010 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11011 @itemize @bullet
11012 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11013 signal from other cores.
11014 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11015 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11016 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11017 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11018 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11019 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11020 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11021 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11022 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11023 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11024 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11025 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11026 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11027 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11028 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11029 @end itemize
11030 @end deffn
11031
11032 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11033 Enable and start performance counter.
11034 @itemize @bullet
11035 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11036 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11037 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11038 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11039 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11040 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11041 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11042 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11043 whether to count.
11044 @end itemize
11045 @end deffn
11046
11047 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11048 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11049 @end deffn
11050
11051 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11052 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11053 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11054 @itemize @bullet
11055 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11056 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11057 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11058 @end itemize
11059 @end deffn
11060
11061 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11062 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11063 @end deffn
11064
11065 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11066 Dump trace memory to a file.
11067 @end deffn
11068
11069 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11070 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11071 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11072 @cindex tracing
11073 @cindex libdcc
11074 @cindex DCC
11075 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11076 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11077 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11078 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11079
11080 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11081 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11082 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11083 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11084 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11085 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11086
11087 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11088 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11089 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11090 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11091 The target being debugged may
11092 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11093 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11094 each supported by a command:
11095
11096 @itemize
11097 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11098 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11099 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11100 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11101
11102 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11103 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11104 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11105
11106 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11107 and then displayed at any time.
11108 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11109
11110 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11111 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11112 @end itemize
11113
11114 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11115 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11116 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11117 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11118 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11119 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11120 does the same thing.
11121
11122 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11123 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11124 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11125 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11126 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11127
11128 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11129 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11130 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11131 @end deffn
11132
11133 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11134 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11135 in the order they triggered.
11136 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11137 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11138 history records.
11139 @end deffn
11140
11141 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11142 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11143 they have been triggered.
11144 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11145 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11146 and associates it with that identifier.
11147
11148 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11149 are not related except by this command.
11150 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11151 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11152 @end deffn
11153
11154
11155 @node JTAG Commands
11156 @chapter JTAG Commands
11157 @cindex JTAG Commands
11158 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11159 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11160 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11161 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11162 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11163
11164 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11165 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11166
11167 @itemize @bullet
11168 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11169 devices such as a CPUs.
11170 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11171 standard state machine (in parallel)
11172 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11173 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11174 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11175 while the reading previous ones.
11176 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11177 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11178 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11179 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11180 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11181 registers.
11182 @end itemize
11183
11184 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11185
11186 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11187 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11188 the order of TAP state transitions.
11189 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11190 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11191 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11192 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11193 these commands are not available.
11194
11195 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11196 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11197 that specify the entire register.
11198 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11199 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11200 The return value holds the original value of each
11201 of those fields.
11202
11203 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11204 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11205 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11206 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11207 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11208
11209 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11210 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11211
11212 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11213 in that state.
11214 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11215 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11216 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11217
11218 @quotation Warning
11219 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11220 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11221 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11222 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11223 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11224 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11225 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11226 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11227 @end quotation
11228 @end deffn
11229
11230 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11231 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11232 This may be used for performance tuning.
11233
11234 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11235 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11236 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11237 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11238 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11239 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11240 @end deffn
11241
11242 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11243 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11244 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11245 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11246 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11247 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11248
11249 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11250 in that state.
11251 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11252 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11253 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11254
11255 @quotation Note
11256 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11257 register values, unlike data register values.
11258 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11259 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11260 @end quotation
11261 @end deffn
11262
11263 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11264 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11265 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11266 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11267 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11268 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11269 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11270 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11271 The final state must also be stable.
11272 @end deffn
11273
11274 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11275 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11276 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11277 Instructions often need some time
11278 to execute before they take effect.
11279 @end deffn
11280
11281 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11282 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11283
11284 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11285 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11286 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11287 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11288 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11289 @end deffn
11290
11291 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11292 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11293 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11294 must also be enabled.
11295 Default is enabled.
11296 @end deffn
11297
11298 @section TAP state names
11299 @cindex TAP state names
11300
11301 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11302 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11303 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11304 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11305
11306 @itemize @bullet
11307 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11308 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11309 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11310 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11311 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11312 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11313 through the data register
11314 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11315 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11316 for update or more shifting
11317 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11318 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11319 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11320 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11321 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11322 through the instruction register
11323 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11324 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11325 for update or more shifting
11326 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11327 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11328 @end itemize
11329
11330 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11331 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11332 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11333 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11334
11335 @itemize @bullet
11336 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11337 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11338 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11339 may not be as expected.
11340 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11341 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11342 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11343 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11344 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11345 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11346 @end itemize
11347
11348 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11349 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11350
11351 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11352 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11353 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11354 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11355
11356 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11357 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11358 @cindex SVF
11359
11360 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11361 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11362 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11363 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11364
11365 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
11366 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
11367 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11368 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11369
11370 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11371 affect their semantics.
11372
11373 Command options:
11374 @itemize @minus
11375 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11376 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11377 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11378 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11379 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11380 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11381 on the real interface;
11382 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
11383 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11384 errors.
11385 @end itemize
11386 @end deffn
11387
11388 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11389 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11390 @cindex XSVF
11391
11392 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11393 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11394 Xilinx devices.
11395 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11396 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11397
11398 @quotation Important
11399 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11400 @end quotation
11401
11402 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11403 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11404 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11405 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11406 that TAP.
11407 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11408 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11409 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11410 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11411 @end deffn
11412
11413 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11414 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11415 after building the software.
11416 You may find them useful:
11417
11418 @itemize
11419 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11420 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11421 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11422 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11423 @end itemize
11424
11425 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11426 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11427 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11428 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11429 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11430 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11431 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11432
11433
11434 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11435 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11436 @cindex IPDBG
11437
11438 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11439 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11440 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11441 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11442 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11443 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11444
11445 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11446 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11447
11448 Command options:
11449 @itemize @bullet
11450 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11451 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11452 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11453 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11454 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11455 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11456 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11457 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11458 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11459 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11460 shift data through vir can be configured.
11461 @end itemize
11462 @end deffn
11463
11464 Examples:
11465 @example
11466 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11467 @end example
11468 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11469 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11470
11471 @example
11472 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11473 @end example
11474 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11475 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11476
11477 @node Utility Commands
11478 @chapter Utility Commands
11479 @cindex Utility Commands
11480
11481 @section RAM testing
11482 @cindex RAM testing
11483
11484 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11485 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11486 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11487 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11488 hardware problems.
11489
11490 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11491 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11492 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11493 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11494
11495 Load the memory testing functions with
11496
11497 @example
11498 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11499 @end example
11500
11501 to get access to the following facilities:
11502
11503 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11504 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11505 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11506 @end deffn
11507
11508 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11509 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11510 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11511 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11512 @end deffn
11513
11514 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11515 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11516 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11517 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11518 @end deffn
11519
11520 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11521 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11522 @end deffn
11523
11524 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11525 @cindex Firmware recovery
11526
11527 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11528 devices recovery with JTAG.
11529
11530 For quickstart instructions run:
11531 @example
11532 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11533 @end example
11534
11535 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11536 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11537 @cindex GDB
11538 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11539 to debug remote targets.
11540 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11541
11542 @itemize
11543 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11544 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11545 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11546 as shown in this chapter.
11547 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11548 that also will probably need to be configured.
11549 @end itemize
11550
11551 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11552 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11553 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11554 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11555 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11556 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11557
11558 @section Connecting to GDB
11559 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11560 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11561 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11562 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11563 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11564
11565 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11566
11567 @enumerate
11568 @item
11569 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11570 @example
11571 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11572 @end example
11573 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11574
11575 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11576 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11577 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11578
11579 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11580 remote command above that becomes:
11581 @example
11582 tar ext :3333
11583 @end example
11584
11585 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11586 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11587 available through the command:
11588 @example
11589 target remote localhost:3333
11590 @end example
11591
11592 @item
11593 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11594 @example
11595 target extended-remote | \
11596 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11597 @end example
11598 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11599 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11600 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11601 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11602 @end enumerate
11603
11604 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11605 GDB command line.
11606
11607 @section Sample GDB session startup
11608
11609 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11610 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11611 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11612 small ARM program.
11613 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11614 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11615
11616 @example
11617 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11618 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11619 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11620 ...
11621 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11622 ...
11623 (gdb) load
11624 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11625 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11626 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11627 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11628 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11629 (gdb) continue
11630 Continuing.
11631 ...
11632 @end example
11633
11634 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11635 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11636 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11637 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11638
11639 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11640
11641 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11642 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11643 packet size and the device's memory map.
11644 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11645 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11646 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11647
11648 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11649 You may need to set those up by hand.
11650 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11651 something like:
11652
11653 @example
11654 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11655 @end example
11656
11657 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11658
11659 @example
11660 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11661 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11662 @end example
11663
11664 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11665 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11666 do not have such restrictions.
11667
11668 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11669 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11670 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11671 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11672
11673 @section Programming using GDB
11674 @cindex Programming using GDB
11675 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11676
11677 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11678 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11679 @example
11680 gdb_memory_map disable
11681 @end example
11682 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11683 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11684 working area.
11685
11686 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11687 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11688 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11689 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11690
11691 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11692 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11693
11694 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11695 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11696 @example
11697 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11698 @end example
11699
11700 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11701 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11702
11703 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11704 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11705 will be used.
11706
11707 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11708 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11709 @example
11710 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11711 @end example
11712 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11713
11714 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11715 can be used.
11716
11717 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11718 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11719 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11720
11721 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11722 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11723 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11724
11725 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11726 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11727 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11728 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11729 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11730 without any intrusion of the target process.
11731
11732 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11733 Place following command after target configuration:
11734 @example
11735 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11736 @end example
11737
11738 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11739 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11740 @example
11741 gdb_memory_map disable
11742 @end example
11743
11744 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11745 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11746 @example
11747 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11748 @end example
11749
11750 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11751 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11752
11753 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11754 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11755 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11756 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11757
11758 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11759 previously shown variables.
11760
11761 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11762 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11763 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11764 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11765 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11766
11767 @section RTOS Support
11768 @cindex RTOS Support
11769 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11770
11771 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11772 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11773
11774 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11775 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11776 GDB commands.
11777
11778 @* An example setup is below:
11779
11780 @example
11781 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11782 @end example
11783
11784 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11785
11786 Currently supported rtos's include:
11787 @itemize @bullet
11788 @item @option{eCos}
11789 @item @option{ThreadX}
11790 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11791 @item @option{linux}
11792 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11793 @item @option{embKernel}
11794 @item @option{mqx}
11795 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11796 @item @option{nuttx}
11797 @item @option{RIOT}
11798 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11799 @item @option{Zephyr}
11800 @end itemize
11801
11802 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11803 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11804
11805 @table @code
11806 @item eCos symbols
11807 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11808 @item ThreadX symbols
11809 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11810 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11811 @raggedright
11812 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11813 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11814 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11815 @end raggedright
11816 @item linux symbols
11817 init_task.
11818 @item ChibiOS symbols
11819 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11820 @item embKernel symbols
11821 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11822 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11823 @item mqx symbols
11824 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11825 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11826 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11827 @item nuttx symbols
11828 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11829 @item RIOT symbols
11830 @raggedright
11831 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11832 _tcb_name_offset.
11833 @end raggedright
11834 @item Zephyr symbols
11835 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11836 @end table
11837
11838 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11839 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11840
11841 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11842 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11843
11844 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11845 along with the project:
11846
11847 @table @code
11848 @item FreeRTOS
11849 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11850 @item uC/OS-III
11851 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11852 @end table
11853
11854 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11855 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11856 @cindex SMP
11857 @cindex RTOS
11858 @cindex hwthread
11859 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11860 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11861 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11862 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11863 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11864 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11865 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11866 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11867 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11868
11869 @node Tcl Scripting API
11870 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11871 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11872 @cindex Tcl scripts
11873 @section API rules
11874
11875 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11876 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11877 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11878
11879 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11880 pair list and lists.
11881
11882 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11883 list.
11884
11885 @example
11886 > set foo(me) Duane
11887 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11888 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11889 > set foo(duck) Donald
11890 @end example
11891
11892 If one does this:
11893
11894 @example
11895 > set foo
11896 @end example
11897
11898 The result is:
11899
11900 @example
11901 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11902 @end example
11903
11904 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11905
11906 @verbatim
11907 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11908 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11909 }
11910 @end verbatim
11911
11912 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11913 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11914
11915 @section Internal low-level Commands
11916
11917 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11918 invoke directly.
11919
11920 @itemize
11921 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11922
11923 Return information about the flash banks
11924
11925 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11926
11927 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11928 its execution. Example:
11929
11930 @example
11931 > capture "reset init"
11932 @end example
11933
11934 @end itemize
11935
11936 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11937 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11938 called "flash_banks".
11939
11940 @section Tcl RPC server
11941 @cindex RPC
11942
11943 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11944 commands and receive the results.
11945
11946 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11947 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11948 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11949 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11950 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11951
11952 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11953 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11954 @command{capture} command.
11955
11956 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11957
11958 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11959 @cindex RPC Notifications
11960
11961 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11962 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11963
11964 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11965 in the following format.
11966
11967 @verbatim
11968 type target_event event [event-name]
11969 type target_state state [state-name]
11970 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11971 @end verbatim
11972
11973 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11974 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11975 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11976 Defaults to off.
11977
11978 @end deffn
11979
11980 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11981 @cindex RPC trace output
11982
11983 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11984 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11985
11986 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11987
11988 @verbatim
11989 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11990 @end verbatim
11991
11992 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11993 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11994 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11995 Defaults to off.
11996
11997 See an example application here:
11998 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11999
12000 @end deffn
12001
12002 @node FAQ
12003 @chapter FAQ
12004 @cindex faq
12005 @enumerate
12006 @anchor{faqrtck}
12007 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12008 @cindex RTCK
12009 @cindex adaptive clocking
12010 @*
12011
12012 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12013 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12014 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12015 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12016
12017 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12018 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12019 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12020 @enumerate
12021 @item
12022 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12023 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12024 @item
12025 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12026 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12027 @end enumerate
12028
12029 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12030 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12031 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12032 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12033 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12034 power).
12035
12036 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12037 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12038 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12039 ARM926 scenario).
12040 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12041 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12042 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12043
12044 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12045 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12046 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12047 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12048
12049 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12050
12051 In order to make use of this,
12052 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12053 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12054
12055 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12056 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12057 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12058 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12059 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12060
12061 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12062 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12063 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12064 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12065
12066 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12067 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12068 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12069 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12070 with a CPLD.
12071 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12072 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12073 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12074 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12075 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12076 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12077
12078 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12079
12080 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12081
12082 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12083 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12084 depending on the chips on your board.
12085 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12086 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12087 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12088
12089 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12090 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12091 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12092
12093 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12094 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12095 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12096 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12097
12098 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12099 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12100 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12101 this way.
12102
12103 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12104 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12105 clock rate.
12106 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12107 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12108 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12109
12110 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12111
12112 @example
12113 # Example: 1.234MHz
12114 adapter speed 1234
12115 @end example
12116
12117
12118 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12119
12120 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12121 around Windows filenames.
12122
12123 @example
12124 > echo \a
12125
12126 > echo @{\a@}
12127 \a
12128 > echo "\a"
12129
12130 >
12131 @end example
12132
12133
12134 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12135
12136 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12137 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12138 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12139
12140 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12141 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12142 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12143
12144 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12145 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12146 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12147
12148 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12149
12150 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12151 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12152 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12153 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12154
12155 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12156 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12157 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12158
12159 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12160 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12161
12162 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12163 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12164 memory read caused data abort".
12165
12166 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12167 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12168 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12169 be done, feel free to add this here.
12170
12171 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12172 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12173 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12174 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12175 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12176 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12177 gracefully stops.
12178
12179 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12180 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12181 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12182
12183 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12184 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12185 bytes. Painful...
12186
12187
12188 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12189 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12190
12191 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12192 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12193 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12194 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12195 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12196 reset, everything else should work fine.
12197
12198 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12199 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12200 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12201 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12202
12203 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12204 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12205 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12206 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12207
12208 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12209
12210 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12211 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12212 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12213
12214 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12215 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12216
12217 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12218 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12219 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12220 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12221 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12222 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12223 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12224 clock frequency?
12225
12226 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12227 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12228 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12229 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12230 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12231
12232 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12233
12234 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12235 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12236 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12237 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12238 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12239 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12240 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12241
12242 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12243
12244 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12245 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12246 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12247 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12248
12249 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12250 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12251 particular order?
12252
12253 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12254 the same order used by the hardware.
12255
12256 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12257 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12258 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12259 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12260 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12261 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12262
12263 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12264 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12265 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12266 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12267
12268 @itemize @bullet
12269 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12270 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12271 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12272 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12273 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12274 @end itemize
12275
12276 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12277
12278 @itemize @bullet
12279 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12280 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12281 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12282 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12283 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12284 @end itemize
12285
12286
12287 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12288 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12289 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12290
12291 TODO.
12292
12293 @end enumerate
12294
12295 @node Tcl Crash Course
12296 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12297 @cindex Tcl
12298
12299 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12300 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12301 how the Tcl scripts work.
12302
12303 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12304 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12305 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12306 OpenOCD.
12307
12308 @section Tcl Rule #1
12309 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12310 @enumerate
12311 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12312 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12313 @end enumerate
12314
12315 The Tcl equal is this:
12316
12317 @enumerate
12318 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12319 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12320 @end enumerate
12321
12322 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12323 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12324
12325 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12326 There is a second pair of rules.
12327 @enumerate
12328 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12329 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12330 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12331 in Tcl.
12332 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12333 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12334 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12335 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12336 @end enumerate
12337
12338 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12339 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12340 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12341 Everything is a string}
12342
12343 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12344 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12345 difference is subtle.
12346 @enumerate
12347 @item Parse Time
12348 @item Evaluation Time
12349 @end enumerate
12350
12351 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12352 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12353 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12354
12355 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12356 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12357 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12358 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12359
12360 @itemize @bullet
12361 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12362 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12363 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12364 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12365 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12366 @example
12367 # bash example
12368 X=`date`
12369 echo "The Date is: $X"
12370 # Tcl example
12371 set X [date]
12372 puts "The Date is: $X"
12373 @end example
12374 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12375 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12376 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12377 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12378 is a string}
12379 @example
12380 set x "Dinner"
12381 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12382 @end example
12383 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12384 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12385 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12386 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12387 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12388 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12389 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12390 @end itemize
12391
12392 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12393
12394 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12395
12396 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12397
12398 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12399 the normal way.
12400
12401 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12402 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12403 line is immediately executed.
12404
12405 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12406 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12407
12408 @subsection Command Execution
12409
12410 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12411 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12412 control flow operators.
12413
12414 Commands are executed like this:
12415
12416 @enumerate
12417 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12418 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12419 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12420 @end enumerate
12421
12422 It sort of works like this:
12423 @example
12424 for(;;)@{
12425 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12426
12427 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12428
12429 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12430 @}
12431 @end example
12432
12433 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12434 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12435 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12436 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12437 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12438 ``LookupCommand()''
12439
12440 @subsection The FOR command
12441
12442 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12443 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12444 command just like any other command.
12445
12446 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12447 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12448 are:
12449
12450 @enumerate 0
12451 @item The ascii text 'for'
12452 @item The start text
12453 @item The test expression
12454 @item The next text
12455 @item The body text
12456 @end enumerate
12457
12458 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12459 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12460 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12461 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12462
12463 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12464 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12465
12466 @example
12467 int
12468 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12469 int *argc,
12470 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12471 @end example
12472
12473 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12474 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12475 still operates in the same basic way.
12476
12477 @subsection FOR command implementation
12478
12479 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12480 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12481
12482 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12483
12484 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12485
12486 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12487 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12488 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12489
12490 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12491 expression and returns a value.
12492
12493 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12494 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12495 @example
12496 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12497
12498 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12499
12500 int
12501 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12502 int argc,
12503 char **argv )
12504 @{
12505 if( argc != 5 )@{
12506 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12507 return ERROR;
12508 @}
12509
12510 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12511
12512 // Execute the start statement.
12513 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12514
12515 // Top of loop test
12516 for(;;)@{
12517 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12518 if( i == 0 )
12519 break;
12520
12521 // Execute the body
12522 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12523
12524 // Execute the LOOP part
12525 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12526 @}
12527
12528 // Return no error
12529 SetResult( interp, "" );
12530 return SUCCESS;
12531 @}
12532 @end example
12533
12534 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12535 in the same basic way.
12536
12537 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12538
12539 @subsection source and find commands
12540 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12541 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12542 @*Remember the parsing rules
12543 @enumerate
12544 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12545 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12546 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12547 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12548 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12549 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12550 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12551 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12552 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12553 @end enumerate
12554 @subsection format command
12555 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12556 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12557 @b{sprintf()}.
12558 @b{Example}
12559 @example
12560 set x 6
12561 set y 7
12562 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12563 @end example
12564 @enumerate
12565 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12566 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12567 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12568 @* Refer to Rule #1
12569 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12570 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12571 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12572 @end enumerate
12573 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12574 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12575 @example
12576 #1 Good
12577 proc someproc @{@} @{
12578 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12579 @}
12580 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12581 #2 Good - no variables
12582 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12583 #3 Good Curly Braces
12584 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12585 puts "Time: [date]"
12586 @}
12587 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12588 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12589 @end example
12590 @enumerate
12591 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12592 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12593 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12594 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12595 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12596 command.
12597 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12598 @*There are 4 examples:
12599 @enumerate
12600 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12601 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12602 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12603 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12604 @end enumerate
12605
12606 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12607 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12608 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12609
12610 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12611 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12612 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12613 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12614 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12615 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12616 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12617 @end enumerate
12618 @subsection Global Variables
12619 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12620 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12621 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12622 @example
12623 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12624 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12625 global x #Global variable X
12626 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12627 @}
12628 @end example
12629 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12630 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12631 @example
12632 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12633 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12634 # Create var name
12635 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12636 # Make it a global
12637 global $vn
12638 # Set it.
12639 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12640 @}
12641 @end example
12642 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12643 @example
12644 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12645 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12646 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12647 @}
12648 @end example
12649
12650 @node License
12651 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12652 @include fdl.texi
12653
12654 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12655 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12656 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12657 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12658 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12659 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12660
12661 @printindex cp
12662
12663 @node Command and Driver Index
12664 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12665 @printindex fn
12666
12667 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)